blob: 480c4a0d2bc079b729d17e116ad85a44b7dcc3d9 [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000024#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
25#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034#include <algorithm>
35
36namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000037using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000038
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000039/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000040static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000041CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
42 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000043 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
44 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000045 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
46 return ExprError();
47
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000048 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000049 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
50 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
51 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000052
53 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000054
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000055 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000056 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
57 if (E.isInvalid())
58 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000059 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000060}
61
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000062static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
63 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000064 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000065 bool CStyle,
66 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000067
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000068static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
69 QualType &ToType,
70 bool InOverloadResolution,
71 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
72 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000073static OverloadingResult
74IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
75 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
76 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
77 bool AllowExplicit);
78
79
80static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
81CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
82 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
83 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
84
85static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
86CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
87 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
88 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
89
90static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
91CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
92 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
93 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
94
95
96
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000097/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
98/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000099ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
101 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
102 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
103 ICC_Identity,
104 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
105 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
106 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000107 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000108 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
109 ICC_Promotion,
110 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000111 ICC_Promotion,
112 ICC_Conversion,
113 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000114 ICC_Conversion,
115 ICC_Conversion,
116 ICC_Conversion,
117 ICC_Conversion,
118 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000119 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000120 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000121 ICC_Conversion,
122 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000123 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000124 ICC_Conversion
125 };
126 return Category[(int)Kind];
127}
128
129/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
130/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
131ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
132 static const ImplicitConversionRank
133 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
134 ICR_Exact_Match,
135 ICR_Exact_Match,
136 ICR_Exact_Match,
137 ICR_Exact_Match,
138 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000139 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000140 ICR_Promotion,
141 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000142 ICR_Promotion,
143 ICR_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Conversion,
147 ICR_Conversion,
148 ICR_Conversion,
149 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000150 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000151 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000152 ICR_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000154 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
155 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000156 ICR_Conversion,
157 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000158 };
159 return Rank[(int)Kind];
160}
161
162/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
163/// implicit conversion.
164const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000165 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000166 "No conversion",
167 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
168 "Array-to-pointer",
169 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000170 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000171 "Qualification",
172 "Integral promotion",
173 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000174 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000175 "Integral conversion",
176 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000177 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000178 "Floating-integral conversion",
179 "Pointer conversion",
180 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000181 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000182 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000183 "Derived-to-base conversion",
184 "Vector conversion",
185 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000186 "Complex-real conversion",
187 "Block Pointer conversion",
188 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000189 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000190 };
191 return Name[Kind];
192}
193
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000194/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
195/// sequence to the identity conversion.
196void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
197 First = ICK_Identity;
198 Second = ICK_Identity;
199 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000200 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000201 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000202 ReferenceBinding = false;
203 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000204 IsLvalueReference = true;
205 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
206 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000207 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000208 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000209 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000212/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
213/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
214/// implicit conversions.
215ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
216 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
217 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
218 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
219 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
220 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
221 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
222 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
223 return Rank;
224}
225
226/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
227/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000228/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000230bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000231 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
232 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
233 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
234 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000235 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000236 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
237 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
238 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000239 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000240 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
241 return true;
242
243 return false;
244}
245
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000246/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
247/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
248/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
249/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000250bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000251StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000252isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000253 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000254 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000255
256 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
257 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
258 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
259 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
260 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
261
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000262 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000263 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000264 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
265
266 return false;
267}
268
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000269/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
270/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
271static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
272 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
273 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
274 case CK_NoOp:
275 case CK_IntegralCast:
276 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
277 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
278 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
279 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
280 case CK_FloatingCast:
281 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
282 continue;
283
284 default:
285 return Converted;
286 }
287 }
288
289 return Converted;
290}
291
292/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
293/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
294///
295/// \param Ctx The AST context.
296/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
297/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
298/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000299/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
300/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000301NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000302StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
303 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000304 APValue &ConstantValue,
305 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000306 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000307
308 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
309 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
310 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
311 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
312 switch (Second) {
313 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
314 //
315 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
316 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
317 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
318 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
319 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
320 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
321 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
322 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
323 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
324 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
325 if (Initializer &&
326 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
327 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
328 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
329 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
330 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
331 // And back.
332 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
333 bool ignored;
334 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
335 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
336 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
337 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
338 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000339 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000340 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
341 }
342 } else {
343 // Variables are always narrowings.
344 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
345 }
346 }
347 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
348
349 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
350 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
351 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
352 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
353 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
354 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
355 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
356 // FromType is larger than ToType.
357 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
358 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
359 // Constant!
360 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
361 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
362 // Convert the source value into the target type.
363 bool ignored;
364 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
365 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
366 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
367 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
368 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000369 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
370 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000371 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000372 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000373 } else {
374 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
375 }
376 }
377 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
378
379 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
380 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
381 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
382 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
383 // value when converted back to the original type.
384 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
385 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
386 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
387 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
388 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
389 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
390 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
391 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
392 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
393 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
394 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
395 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
396 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
397
398 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000399 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
400 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000401 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
402 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
403 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000404 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
405 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
406 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000407 }
408 bool Narrowing = false;
409 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000410 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
411 // narrowing.
412 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000413 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000414 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000415 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
416 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
417 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
418 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
419 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
420 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
421 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
422 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
423 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
424 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
425 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000426 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
427 Narrowing = true;
428 }
429 if (Narrowing) {
430 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
431 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
432 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000433 }
434 }
435 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
436 }
437
438 default:
439 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
440 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
441 }
442}
443
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000444/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
445/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
446void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000447 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000448 bool PrintedSomething = false;
449 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000450 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000451 PrintedSomething = true;
452 }
453
454 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
455 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000456 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000457 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000458 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000459
460 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000461 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000462 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000463 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000464 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000465 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000466 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000467 PrintedSomething = true;
468 }
469
470 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
471 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000473 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000474 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000475 PrintedSomething = true;
476 }
477
478 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000479 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000480 }
481}
482
483/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
484/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
485void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000486 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000487 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
488 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000489 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000490 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000491 if (ConversionFunction)
492 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
493 else
494 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000495 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000496 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000497 After.DebugPrint();
498 }
499}
500
501/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
502/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
503void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000504 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000505 switch (ConversionKind) {
506 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000507 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000508 Standard.DebugPrint();
509 break;
510 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000511 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000512 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
513 break;
514 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000515 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000516 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000517 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000518 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000519 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000520 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000521 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000522 break;
523 }
524
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000525 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000526}
527
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000528void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
529 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
530}
531
532void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
533 conversions().~ConversionSet();
534}
535
536void
537AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
538 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
539 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
540 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
541}
542
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000543namespace {
544 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000545 // template argument information.
546 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000547 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
548 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
549 };
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000550 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
551 // template parameter and template argument information.
552 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
553 TemplateParameter Param;
554 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000555}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000556
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000557/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
558/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
559OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000560static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
561 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000562 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000563 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
564 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000565 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000566 Result.Data = 0;
567 switch (TDK) {
568 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000569 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000570 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000571 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
572 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000573 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000574
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000575 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000576 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000577 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
578 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000579
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000580 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
581 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
582 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
583 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
584 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
585 Result.Data = Saved;
586 break;
587 }
588
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000589 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000590 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000591 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
592 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000593 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
594 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
595 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
596 Result.Data = Saved;
597 break;
598 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000599
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000600 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000601 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000602 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
603 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
604 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
605 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
606 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
607 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000608 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000609
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000611 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
612 break;
613
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000614 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000615 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000616 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000617
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000618 return Result;
619}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000620
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000621void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
622 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
623 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000624 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000625 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
626 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000627 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
628 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000629 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000630 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000631 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000632
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000633 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000634 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000635 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000636 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000637 Data = 0;
638 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000639
640 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000641 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000642 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000643 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
644 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
645 HasDiagnostic = false;
646 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000647 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000648
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000649 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000650 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000651 break;
652 }
653}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000654
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000655PartialDiagnosticAt *
656OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
657 if (HasDiagnostic)
658 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
659 return 0;
660}
661
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000662TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000663OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
664 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
665 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000666 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000667 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000668 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
669 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000670 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000671 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
672 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000673 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000674
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000675 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000676 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000677 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000678
679 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000680 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000681 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000682
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000683 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000685 break;
686 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000687
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000688 return TemplateParameter();
689}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000690
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000691TemplateArgumentList *
692OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
693 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000694 case Sema::TDK_Success:
695 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
696 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
697 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
698 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
699 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
700 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
701 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
702 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
703 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
704 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
705 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000706
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000707 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
708 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000709
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000710 // Unhandled
711 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
712 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000713 }
714
715 return 0;
716}
717
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000718const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
719 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
720 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000721 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000722 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
723 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000724 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
725 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000726 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000727 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000728 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 return 0;
730
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000732 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000733 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
734 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000735
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000736 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000737 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000738 break;
739 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000740
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000741 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000742}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000743
744const TemplateArgument *
745OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
746 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
747 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000748 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000749 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
750 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000751 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
752 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000753 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000754 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000755 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000756 return 0;
757
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000758 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000759 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000760 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
761 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000762
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000763 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000764 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000765 break;
766 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000767
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000768 return 0;
769}
770
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000771Expr *
772OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
773 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
774 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
775 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
776
777 return 0;
778}
779
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000780void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000781 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000782 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
783 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000784 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
785 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
786 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000787}
788
789void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
790 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000791 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000792 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000793 Functions.clear();
794}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000795
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000796namespace {
797 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
798 struct Entry {
799 Expr **Addr;
800 Expr *Saved;
801 };
802 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
803
804 public:
805 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
806 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
807 Entry entry = { &E, E };
808 Entries.push_back(entry);
809 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
810 }
811
812 void restore() {
813 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
814 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
815 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
816 }
817 };
818}
819
820/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
821/// preprocessing on the given expression.
822///
823/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
824/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
825///
826/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
827static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
828 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000829 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
830 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
831 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
832 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
833
834 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
835 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
836 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
837 unbridgedCasts) {
838 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
839 return false;
840 }
841
842 // Go ahead and check everything else.
843 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
844 if (result.isInvalid())
845 return true;
846
847 E = result.take();
848 return false;
849 }
850
851 // Nothing to do.
852 return false;
853}
854
855/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
856/// placeholders.
857static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
858 unsigned numArgs,
859 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
860 for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
861 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
862 return true;
863
864 return false;
865}
866
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000867// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000868// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
869// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
870// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
871// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000872// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
873// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
874// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000875//
876// Example: Given the following input:
877//
878// void f(int, float); // #1
879// void f(int, int); // #2
880// int f(int, int); // #3
881//
882// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000883// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000884//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000885// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
886// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
887// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
888// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000889//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000890// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
891// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
892// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
893// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000894// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
895// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000896//
897// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
898// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
899// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
900// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000901Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000902Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
903 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000904 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000905 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000906 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
907
908 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
909 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
910 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
911
912 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
913 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
914 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
915
916 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
917 }
918
919 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
920 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
921 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
922 // function templates hide function templates with different
923 // return types or template parameter lists.
924 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
John McCall78037ac2013-04-03 21:19:47 +0000925 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
926 !New->getFriendObjectKind();
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000927
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000928 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000929 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
930 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
931 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
932 continue;
933 }
934
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000935 Match = *I;
936 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000937 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000938 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000939 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
940 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
941 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
942 continue;
943 }
944
Rafael Espindola90cc3902013-04-15 12:49:13 +0000945 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
946 continue;
947
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000948 Match = *I;
949 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000950 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000951 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000952 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
953 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
954 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000955 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
956 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000957 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
958 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
959 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
960 // template instantiation.
961 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000962 // (C++ 13p1):
963 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
964 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000965 Match = *I;
966 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000967 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000968 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000969
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000970 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000971}
972
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000973static bool canBeOverloaded(const FunctionDecl &D) {
974 if (D.getAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
975 return true;
Rafael Espindolad2fdd422013-02-14 01:47:04 +0000976 if (D.isExternC())
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000977 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000978
979 // Main cannot be overloaded (basic.start.main).
980 if (D.isMain())
981 return false;
982
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000983 return true;
984}
985
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +0000986static bool shouldTryToOverload(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
987 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000988 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
989 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
990
991 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
992 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
993 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
994 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
995 return true;
996
997 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +0000998 QualType OldQType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
999 QualType NewQType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001000
1001 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1002 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1003 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1004
1005 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1006 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1007 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1008 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1009 return false;
1010
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001011 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1012 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001013
1014 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1015 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1016 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1017 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1018 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1019 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001020 !S.FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001021 return true;
1022
1023 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1024 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1025 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1026 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1027 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1028 // signature.
1029 //
1030 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1031 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001032 //
1033 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1034 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1035 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001036 (!S.TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1037 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1038 false, S.TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001039 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1040 return true;
1041
1042 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001043 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001044 //
1045 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1046 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1047 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1048 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1049 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001050 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1051 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001052 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001053 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1054 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1055 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1056 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1057 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1058 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1059 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1060 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1061 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1062 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1063 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001064 S.Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001065 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001066 S.Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001067 }
1068 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001069 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001070
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001071 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1072 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1073 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1074 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1075 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith714fcc12013-01-14 08:00:39 +00001076 if (NewMethod->isConstexpr() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001077 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1078 if (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewQuals)
1079 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001080 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001081
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001082 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1083 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001084}
1085
Rafael Espindola2d1b0962013-03-14 03:07:35 +00001086bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1087 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
1088 if (!shouldTryToOverload(*this, New, Old, UseUsingDeclRules))
1089 return false;
1090
1091 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
1092 // overloads.
1093 if (!canBeOverloaded(*Old) && !canBeOverloaded(*New))
1094 return false;
1095
1096 return true;
1097}
1098
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001099/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1100/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1101///
1102/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1103/// an available function, false otherwise.
1104bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1105 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1106}
1107
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001108/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1109///
1110/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1111/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1112static ImplicitConversionSequence
1113TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1114 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1115 bool AllowExplicit,
1116 bool InOverloadResolution,
1117 bool CStyle,
1118 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1119 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1120
1121 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1122 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1123 // we can perform.
1124 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1125 return ICS;
1126 }
1127
1128 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1129 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1130 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1131 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
1132 AllowExplicit);
1133
1134 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1135 ICS.setUserDefined();
1136 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1137 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1138 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1139 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1140 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1141 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1142 // called for those cases.
1143 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1144 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1145 QualType FromCanon
1146 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1147 QualType ToCanon
1148 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1149 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1150 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1151 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1152 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1153 ICS.setStandard();
1154 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1155 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1156 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1157 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1158 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1159 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1160 }
1161 }
1162
1163 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1164 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1165 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1166 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1167 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1168 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1169 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1170 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1171 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1172 }
1173 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1174 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1175 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1176 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1177 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1178 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1179 if (Cand->Viable)
1180 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1181 } else {
1182 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1183 }
1184
1185 return ICS;
1186}
1187
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001188/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1189/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1190/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1191/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001192///
1193/// void f(float f);
1194/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1195///
1196/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1197/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1198/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1199/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1200//
1201/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1202/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1203/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1204/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1205/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001206///
1207/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1208/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001209/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1210/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001211///
1212/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1213/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1214/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001215static ImplicitConversionSequence
1216TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1217 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001218 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001219 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001220 bool CStyle,
1221 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001222 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001223 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001224 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001225 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001226 return ICS;
1227 }
1228
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001229 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001230 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001231 return ICS;
1232 }
1233
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001234 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1235 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1236 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1237 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1238 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1239 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1240 // called for those cases.
1241 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1242 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1244 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001245 ICS.setStandard();
1246 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1247 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1248 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001249
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001250 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1251 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1252 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1253 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1254 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001255
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001256 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001257 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001258 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001259
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001260 return ICS;
1261 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001262
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001263 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1264 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1265 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001266}
1267
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001268ImplicitConversionSequence
1269Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1270 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1271 bool AllowExplicit,
1272 bool InOverloadResolution,
1273 bool CStyle,
1274 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1275 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1276 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1277 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1278 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001279}
1280
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001281/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001282/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001283/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1284/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1285/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001286ExprResult
1287Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001288 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001289 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001290 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001291}
1292
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001293ExprResult
1294Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001295 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001296 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001297 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1298 return ExprError();
1299
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1301 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001302 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001303 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001304
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001305 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1306 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1307 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001308 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001309 /*CStyle=*/false,
1310 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001311 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1312}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001313
1314/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001315/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001316bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1317 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001318 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1319 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001320
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001321 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1322 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1323 // - a pointer
1324 // - a member pointer
1325 // - a block pointer
1326 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1327 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1328 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1329 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1330 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1331 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1332 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1333 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1334 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1335 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1336 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1337 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1338 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1339 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1340 } else {
1341 return false;
1342 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001343
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001344 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1345 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1346 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1347 return false;
1348 }
1349
1350 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1351 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1352 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1353
1354 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1355 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1356 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1357
1358 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001359 return true;
1360}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001361
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001362/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1363/// vector conversion.
1364///
1365/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1366/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001367static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1368 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001369 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1370 // conversion.
1371 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1372 return false;
1373
1374 // Identical types require no conversions.
1375 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1376 return false;
1377
1378 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1379 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1380 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1381 // identity conversion.
1382 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1383 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001384
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001385 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001386 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001387 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1388 return true;
1389 }
1390 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001391
1392 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1393 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1394 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1395 // same size
1396 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1397 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001398 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001399 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001400 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1401 return true;
1402 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001403 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001404
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001405 return false;
1406}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001407
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001408static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1409 bool InOverloadResolution,
1410 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1411 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001412
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001413/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1414/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1415/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1416/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1417/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1418/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1419/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1420/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001421static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1422 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001423 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001424 bool CStyle,
1425 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001426 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001427
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001428 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001429 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001430 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001431 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001432 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001433 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001434
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001435 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001436 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001437 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001438 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001439 return false;
1440
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001441 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001442 }
1443
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001444 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1445 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1446 // (C++ 4p1).
1447
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001448 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001449 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1450 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001451 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001452 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001453 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1454 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1455 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001456
1457 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1458 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1459 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1460 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1461 QualType resultTy;
1462 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001463 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001464 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1465 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1466 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1467 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001468 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001469
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001470 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1471 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1472 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1473 // expression.
1474 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1475 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1476 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1477 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1478 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1479 == UO_AddrOf &&
1480 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1481 const Type *ClassType
1482 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1483 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001484 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1485 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1486 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001487 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1488 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1489 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001490
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001491 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001492 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1493 FromType,
1494 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001495 } else {
1496 return false;
1497 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001498 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001499 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1500 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1501 // be converted to a prvalue.
1502 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001503 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001504 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001505 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001506 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001507
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001508 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1509 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1510 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1511 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1512 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1513
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001514 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1515 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001516 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1517 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001518 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001519 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1520 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001521 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001522
1523 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1524 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1525 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001526 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001527
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001528 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001529 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001530 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001531
1532 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1533 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1534 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1535 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001536 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1537 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001538 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001539 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001540 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001541 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001542 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001543 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001544 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001545
1546 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1547 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1548 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001549 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001550 } else {
1551 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001552 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001553 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001554 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001555
1556 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1557 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1558 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1559 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001560 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1561 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001562 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001563 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001564 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001565 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1566 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001567 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001568 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001569 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001570 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001571 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001572 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001573 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001574 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001575 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001576 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001577 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001578 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1579 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001580 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1581 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1582 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1583 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1584 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1585 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1586 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1587 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1588 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001589 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001590 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001591 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001592 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001593 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001594 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001595 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001596 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1597 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001598 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1599 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001600 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1601 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1602 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001603 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001604 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1605 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1606 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001607 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001608 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001609 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001610 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001611 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001612 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001613 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001614 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001615 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1616 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1617 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1618 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001619 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1620 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001621 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001622 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001623 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001624 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001625 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001626 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001627 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001628 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001629 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001630 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1631 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001632 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001633 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001634 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001635 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001636 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001637 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001638 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1639 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001640 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1641 InOverloadResolution,
1642 SCS, CStyle)) {
1643 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1644 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001645 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1646 CStyle)) {
1647 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001648 // appropriately.
1649 return true;
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001650 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1651 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1652 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1653 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1654 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 } else {
1656 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001657 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001658 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001659 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001660
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001661 QualType CanonFrom;
1662 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001663 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001664 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1665 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1666 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001667 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001668 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001669 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001670 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1671 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001672 } else {
1673 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001674 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1675
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001676 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001677 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1678 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1679 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001680 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1681 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001682 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001683 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault5509f372013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001684 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001685 FromType = ToType;
1686 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1687 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001688 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001689 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001690
1691 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1692 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001693 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001694 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001695
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001696 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001697}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001698
1699static bool
1700IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1701 QualType &ToType,
1702 bool InOverloadResolution,
1703 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1704 bool CStyle) {
1705
1706 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1707 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1708 return false;
1709 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1710 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1711 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1712 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1713 itend = UD->field_end();
1714 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001715 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1716 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001717 ToType = it->getType();
1718 return true;
1719 }
1720 }
1721 return false;
1722}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001723
1724/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1725/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1726/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1727/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001728bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001729 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001730 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001731 if (!To) {
1732 return false;
1733 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001734
1735 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1736 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1737 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1738 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1739 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001740 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1741 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001742 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1743 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1744 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1745 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001746 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001747 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001748 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001749 }
1750
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001751 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1752 }
1753
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001754 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001755 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1756 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1757 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1758 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1759 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001760 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001761 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001762 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001763 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1764 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001765 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001766 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1767 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1768 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1769 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1770 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1771 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001772 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1773 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1774 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1775 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1776 return false;
1777
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001778 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1779 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1780 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1781 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1782 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1783 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1784 }
1785
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001786 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001787 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001788 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001789 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1790 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001791 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001792
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001793 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001794 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1795 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1796 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001797 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001798 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001799 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001800 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001801 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001802 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001803 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001804 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1805 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001806 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001807 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001808
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001809 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1810 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001811 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1812 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001813 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1814 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001815 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001816 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001817 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1818 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001819 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001820 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1821 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1822 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1823 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001824 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001825 }
1826 }
1827 }
1828
1829 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1830 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1831 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1832 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1833 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1834 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1835 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001836 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1837 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001838 using llvm::APSInt;
1839 if (From)
1840 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001841 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001842 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001843 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1844 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1845 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001846
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001847 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1848 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1849 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1850 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1851 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001852
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001853 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1854 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1855 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1856 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1857 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001858
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001859 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001860 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001861 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001862
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001863 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1864 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001865 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001866 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001867 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001868
1869 return false;
1870}
1871
1872/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1873/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1874/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001875bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001876 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1877 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001878 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1879 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001880 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1881 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1882 return true;
1883
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001884 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1885 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1886 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001887 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001888 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1889 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1890 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1891 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001892
1893 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001894 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1895 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001896 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1897 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001898 }
1899
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001900 return false;
1901}
1902
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001903/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1904///
1905/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1906/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001907/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001908bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001909 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001910 if (!FromComplex)
1911 return false;
1912
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001913 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001914 if (!ToComplex)
1915 return false;
1916
1917 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001918 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1919 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1920 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001921}
1922
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001923/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1924/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1925/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1926/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1927/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001928///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001929static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001930BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001931 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001932 ASTContext &Context,
1933 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001934 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1935 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1936 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001937
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001938 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1939 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001940 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001941
1942 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001943 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001944 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001945 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001946
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001947 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1948 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1949
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001950 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001951 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001952 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001953 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001954 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001955
1956 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1957 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001958 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1959 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001960 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1961 }
1962
1963 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001964 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1965 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001966
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001967 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1968 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1969 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001970}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001971
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001972static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001973 bool InOverloadResolution,
1974 ASTContext &Context) {
1975 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1976 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1977 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001978 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001979 return !InOverloadResolution;
1980
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001981 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1982 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1983 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001984}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001985
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001986/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1987/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1988/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1989/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1990/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1991/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001992///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001993/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1994/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1995/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1996/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1997/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1998/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001999/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2000/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2001/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002002bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00002003 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002004 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002005 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002006 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002007 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2008 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002009 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002010
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002011 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2012 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002013 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002014 ConvertedType = ToType;
2015 return true;
2016 }
2017
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002018 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2019 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002020 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002021 ConvertedType = ToType;
2022 return true;
2023 }
2024 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2025 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002026 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002027 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002028 ConvertedType = ToType;
2029 return true;
2030 }
2031
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002032 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2033 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002034 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002035 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002036 ConvertedType = ToType;
2037 return true;
2038 }
2039
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002040 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002041 if (!ToTypePtr)
2042 return false;
2043
2044 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002045 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002046 ConvertedType = ToType;
2047 return true;
2048 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002049
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002050 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002051 // , including objective-c pointers.
2052 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002053 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002054 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002055 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2056 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2057 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002058 ToType, Context);
2059 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002060 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002061 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002062 if (!FromTypePtr)
2063 return false;
2064
2065 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002066
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002067 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002068 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2069 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2070 return false;
2071
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002072 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2073 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2074 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002075 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2076 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002077 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002078 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002079 ToType, Context,
2080 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002081 return true;
2082 }
2083
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002084 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002085 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002086 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2087 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2088 ToPointeeType,
2089 ToType, Context);
2090 return true;
2091 }
2092
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002093 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2094 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002095 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002096 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002097 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002098 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002099 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002100 return true;
2101 }
2102
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002103 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002104 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002105 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2106 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2107 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2108 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2109 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2110 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2111 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2112 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2113 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002114 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2115 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002116 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002117 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002118 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002119 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002120 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002121 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002122 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002123 ToType, Context);
2124 return true;
2125 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002126
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002127 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2128 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2129 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2130 ToPointeeType,
2131 ToType, Context);
2132 return true;
2133 }
2134
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002135 return false;
2136}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002137
2138/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2139static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2140 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2141
2142 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2143 if (TQs == Qs)
2144 return T;
2145
2146 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2147 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2148
2149 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2150}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002151
2152/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2153/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2154/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002156 QualType& ConvertedType,
2157 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002158 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002159 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002160
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002161 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2162 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2163
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002164 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002165 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2166 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002167 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002168 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002169
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002170 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002171 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2172 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2173 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2174 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2175 return false;
2176
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002177 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002178 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002179 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002180 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002181 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002182 return true;
2183 }
2184 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002185 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002186 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002187 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002188 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002189 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002190 return true;
2191 }
2192 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2193 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2194 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002195 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2196 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002197 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002198 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2199 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2200 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002201 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002202 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2203 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002204 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002205 return true;
2206 }
2207
2208 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2209 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2210 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2211 // complain about it.
2212 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002213 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002214 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2215 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002216 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002217 return true;
2218 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002219 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002220 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002221 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002222 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002223 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002224 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002225 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002226 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002227 // to a block pointer type.
2228 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002229 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002230 return true;
2231 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002232 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002233 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002234 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002235 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002236 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002237 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002238 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002239 return true;
2240 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002241 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002242 return false;
2243
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002244 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002245 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002246 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002247 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2248 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002249 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2250 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002251 return false;
2252
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002253 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2254 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2255 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2256 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2257 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2258 // We always complain about this conversion.
2259 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002260 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002261 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002262 return true;
2263 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002264 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2265 // as in I* to id.
2266 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2267 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2268 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2269 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002270
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002271 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002272 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002273 return true;
2274 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002275
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002276 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002277 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2278 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2279 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002280 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002281 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002282 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002283 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002284 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2285 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2286 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2287 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2288 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2289 return false;
2290
2291 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2292 // function types are obviously different.
2293 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2294 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2295 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2296 return false;
2297
2298 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2299 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2300 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2301 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2302 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2303 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2304 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2305 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2306 HasObjCConversion = true;
2307 } else {
2308 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2309 return false;
2310 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002312 // Check argument types.
2313 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2314 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2315 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2316 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2317 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2318 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2319 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2320 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2321 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2322 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2323 HasObjCConversion = true;
2324 } else {
2325 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2326 return false;
2327 }
2328 }
2329
2330 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2331 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2332 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002333 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002334 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2335 return true;
2336 }
2337 }
2338
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002339 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002340}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002341
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002342/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2343/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2344///
2345/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2346///
2347/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2348///
2349/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2350/// this conversion.
2351bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2352 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002353 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002354 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2355 return false;
2356
2357 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2358 QualType ToPointee;
2359 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2360 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2361 else
2362 return false;
2363
2364 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2365 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2366 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002367 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002368 return false;
2369
2370 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2371 QualType FromPointee;
2372 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2373 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2374 else
2375 return false;
2376
2377 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2378 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2379 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2380 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2381 return false;
2382
2383 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2384 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2385 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2386 return false;
2387
2388 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2389 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2390 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2391 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2392
2393 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2394 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2395 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2396 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2397 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2398 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2399 IncompatibleObjC))
2400 return false;
2401
2402 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2403 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2404 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2405 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2406 return true;
2407}
2408
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002409bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2410 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2411 QualType ToPointeeType;
2412 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2413 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2414 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2415 else
2416 return false;
2417
2418 QualType FromPointeeType;
2419 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2420 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2421 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2422 else
2423 return false;
2424 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2425 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2426 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2427
2428 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2429 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2430 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2431 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2432
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002433 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2434 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002435
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002436 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002437 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002438
2439 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2440 // function types are obviously different.
2441 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2442 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2443 return false;
2444
2445 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2446 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2447 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2448 return false;
2449
2450 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002451 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2452 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002453 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2454 } else {
2455 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2456 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002457 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002458 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2459 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2460
2461 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2462 // OK exact match.
2463 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2464 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2465 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2466 return false;
2467 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2468 }
2469 else
2470 return false;
2471 }
2472
2473 // Check argument types.
2474 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2475 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2476 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2477 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2478 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2479 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2480 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2481 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2482 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2483 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2484 return false;
2485 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2486 } else
2487 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2488 return false;
2489 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002490 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2491 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2492 ToFunctionType))
2493 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002494
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002495 ConvertedType = ToType;
2496 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002497}
2498
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002499enum {
2500 ft_default,
2501 ft_different_class,
2502 ft_parameter_arity,
2503 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2504 ft_return_type,
2505 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2506};
2507
2508/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2509/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2510/// parameter types, and different return types.
2511void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2512 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002513 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2514 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2515 PDiag << ft_default;
2516 return;
2517 }
2518
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002519 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2520 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2521 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2522 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2523 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2524 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2525 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2526 return;
2527 }
2528 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2529 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002530 }
2531
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002532 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2533 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2534 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2535 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2536
2537 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002538 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2539 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2540
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002541 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2542 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2543 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2544 PDiag << ft_default;
2545 return;
2546 }
2547
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002548 // No extra info for same types.
2549 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2550 PDiag << ft_default;
2551 return;
2552 }
2553
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002554 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2555 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2556
2557 // Both types need to be function types.
2558 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2559 PDiag << ft_default;
2560 return;
2561 }
2562
2563 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2564 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2565 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2566 return;
2567 }
2568
2569 // Handle different parameter types.
2570 unsigned ArgPos;
2571 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2572 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2573 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2574 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2575 return;
2576 }
2577
2578 // Handle different return type.
2579 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2580 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2581 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2582 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2583 return;
2584 }
2585
2586 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2587 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2588 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2589 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2590 return;
2591 }
2592
2593 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2594 PDiag << ft_default;
2595}
2596
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002597/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002598/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002599/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2600/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
Sylvestre Ledrubed28ac2012-07-23 08:59:39 +00002601/// If the parameters are different, ArgPos will have the parameter index
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002602/// of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002603bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002604 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2605 unsigned *ArgPos) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002606 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002607 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2608 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2609 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2610 if (!Context.hasSameType(*O, *N)) {
2611 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2612 return false;
2613 }
2614 }
2615 return true;
2616 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002617
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002618 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2619 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2620 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2621 QualType ToType = (*O);
2622 QualType FromType = (*N);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002623 if (!Context.hasSameType(ToType, FromType)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002624 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2625 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002626 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2627 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2628 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2629 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002630 continue;
2631 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002632 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2633 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002634 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002635 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002636 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2637 PTTo->getObjectType()->getBaseType(),
2638 PTFr->getObjectType()->getBaseType()))
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002639 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002640 }
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002641 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002642 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002643 }
2644 }
2645 return true;
2646}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002647
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002648/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2649/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002650/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002651/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2652/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2653/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002654bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002655 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002656 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002657 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002658 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002659 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002660
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002661 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2662
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002663 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2664 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2665 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2666 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2667 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2668 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2669 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2670 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2671 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2672 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2673 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002674 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2675 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002676 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2677 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002678
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002679 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2680 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002681 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2682 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002683 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2684 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002685 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002686 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002687 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002688
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002689 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002690 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002691 }
2692 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002693 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2694 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2695 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2696 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002697 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2698 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2699 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002700 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002701 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002702 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2703 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2704 } else {
2705 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002706 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002707 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2708 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2709 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002710 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002711
2712 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2713 // reasons.
2714 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2715 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2716
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002717 return false;
2718}
2719
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002720/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2721/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2722/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2723/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2724/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2725bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002726 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002727 bool InOverloadResolution,
2728 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002729 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002730 if (!ToTypePtr)
2731 return false;
2732
2733 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002734 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2735 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2736 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002737 ConvertedType = ToType;
2738 return true;
2739 }
2740
2741 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002742 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002743 if (!FromTypePtr)
2744 return false;
2745
2746 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2747 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2748 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2749 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002750
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002751 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002752 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002753 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002754 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2755 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2756 return true;
2757 }
2758
2759 return false;
2760}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002761
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002762/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2763/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002764/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002765/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2766/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2767/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002768bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002769 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002770 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002771 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002772 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002773 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002774 if (!FromPtrType) {
2775 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002776 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002777 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002778 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002779 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002780 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002781 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002782
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002783 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002784 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2785 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002786
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002787 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2788 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002789
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002790 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2791 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2792 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002793
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002794 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002795 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002796 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2797 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2798 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2799 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002800
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002801 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2802 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002803 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2804 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2805 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2806 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002807 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002808
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002809 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002810 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2811 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2812 << From->getSourceRange();
2813 return true;
2814 }
2815
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002816 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002817 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2818 Paths.front(),
2819 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002820
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002821 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002822 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002823 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002824 return false;
2825}
2826
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002827/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2828/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2829/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002830///
2831/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2832/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2833/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002834bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002835Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002836 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002837 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2838 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002839 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2840
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002841 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2842 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002843 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002844 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002845
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002846 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2847 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2848 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2849 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002850 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002851 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002852 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2853 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2854 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002855 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002856 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2857 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002858 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002859
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002860 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2861 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2862
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002863 // Objective-C ARC:
2864 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2865 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2866 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2867 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2868 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2869 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2870 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2871 } else {
2872 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2873 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2874 return false;
2875 }
2876 }
2877
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002878 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2879 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2880 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2881 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2882 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2883 }
2884
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002885 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2886 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002887 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002888 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002889
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002890 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2891 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002892 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002893 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002894 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002895
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002896 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2897 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002898 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002899 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002900 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002901
2902 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2903 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2904 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2905 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2906 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002907 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002908}
2909
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002910/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2911/// atomic type.
2912///
2913/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2914/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002915static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2916 bool InOverloadResolution,
2917 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2918 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002919 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2920 if (!ToAtomic)
2921 return false;
2922
2923 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2924 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2925 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2926 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2927 return false;
2928
2929 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2930 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2931 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2932 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2933 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2934 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2935 return true;
2936}
2937
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002938static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2939 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2940 QualType Type) {
2941 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2942 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2943 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2944 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2945 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2946 return true;
2947 }
2948 return false;
2949}
2950
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002951static OverloadingResult
2952IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2953 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2954 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2955 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2956 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002957 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2958 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002959 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2960 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2961 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2962
2963 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2964 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2965 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2966 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2967 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2968 Constructor
2969 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2970 else
2971 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2972
2973 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2974 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2975 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2976 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002977 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2978 // suppress conversions.
2979 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2980 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002981 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2982 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2983 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002984 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002985 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002986 else
2987 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002988 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002989 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002990 }
2991 }
2992
2993 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2994
2995 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2996 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2997 case OR_Success: {
2998 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2999 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003000 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3001 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3002 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3003 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3004 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3005 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3006 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3007 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3008 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3009 return OR_Success;
3010 }
3011
3012 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3013 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3014 case OR_Deleted:
3015 return OR_Deleted;
3016 case OR_Ambiguous:
3017 return OR_Ambiguous;
3018 }
3019
3020 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3021}
3022
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003023/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3024/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3025/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3026/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3027/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3028/// false and User is unspecified.
3029///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00003030/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3031/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3032/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003033static OverloadingResult
3034IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003035 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3036 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003037 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003038 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3039 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3040
3041 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3042 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003043 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003044 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3045 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3046 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3047 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3048 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3049 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3050 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3051 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003052 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003053 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003054 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003055 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3056
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003057 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003058 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3059 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3060 // to try to recover.
3061 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003062 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3063 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3064 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003065
3066 Expr **Args = &From;
3067 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3068 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003069 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003070 // But first, see if there is an init-list-contructor that will work.
3071 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3072 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3073 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3074 return Result;
3075 // Never mind.
3076 CandidateSet.clear();
3077
3078 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3079 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003080 Args = InitList->getInits();
3081 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3082 ListInitializing = true;
3083 }
3084
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003085 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3086 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003087 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003088 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3089 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3090
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003091 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3092 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3093 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003094 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003095 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003096 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003097 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3098 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003099 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003100
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003101 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3102 if (ListInitializing)
3103 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3104 else
3105 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3106 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003107 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3108 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3109 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3110 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3111 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3112 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003113 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3114 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003115 }
3116 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003117 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003118 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3119 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003120 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003121 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003122 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003123 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3124 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003125 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003126 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003127 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003128 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003129 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003130 }
3131 }
3132
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003133 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003134 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003135 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003136 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003137 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003138 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003139 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003140 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3141 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003142 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3143 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3144 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3145 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3146 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003147 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3148 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003149 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3150 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3151 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3152
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003153 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3154 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003155 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3156 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003157 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003158 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003159
3160 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3161 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003162 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3163 ActingContext, From, ToType,
3164 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003165 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003166 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3167 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003168 }
3169 }
3170 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003171 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003172
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003173 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3174
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003175 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003176 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003177 case OR_Success:
3178 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3179 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3180 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3181 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3182 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3183 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3184 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3185 // the argument of the constructor.
3186 //
3187 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003188 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3189 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3190 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3191 } else {
3192 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3193 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3194 else {
3195 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3196 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3197 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003198 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003199 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003200 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003201 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003202 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3203 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3204 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3205 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003206 }
3207 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003208 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3209 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3210 //
3211 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3212 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3213 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3214 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3215 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003216 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003217 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003218 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003219 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003220
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003221 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3222 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3223 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3224 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3225 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3226 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3227 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3228 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3229 // 13.3.3.1).
3230 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3231 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003232 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003233 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003234
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003235 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3236 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3237 case OR_Deleted:
3238 // No conversion here! We're done.
3239 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003240
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003241 case OR_Ambiguous:
3242 return OR_Ambiguous;
3243 }
3244
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003245 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003246}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003247
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003248bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003249Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003250 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003251 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003252 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003253 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003254 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003255 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003256 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003257 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3258 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3259 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003260 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003261 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3262 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3263 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003264 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003265 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003266 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003267}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003268
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003269/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3270/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3271/// is possible.
3272static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3273compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3274 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3275 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003276 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003277 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3278
3279 // Objective-C++:
3280 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3281 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3282 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3283 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3284 // to keep code working.
3285 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3286 if (!Conv1)
3287 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3288
3289 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3290 if (!Conv2)
3291 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3292
3293 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3294 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3295 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3296 if (Block1 != Block2)
3297 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3298 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3299 }
3300
3301 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3302}
3303
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003304/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3305/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3306/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003307static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3308CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3309 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3310 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003311{
3312 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3313 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3314 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3315 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3316 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3317 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3318 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3319 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003320 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003321 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3322 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3323 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3324 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3325 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003326 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3327 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003328 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003329 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003330
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003331 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3332 // the same kind.
3333 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3334 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3335
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003336 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3337 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3338
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003339 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3340 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3341 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003342 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003343 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3344 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003345 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003346 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3347 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3348 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3349 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3350 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3351 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003352 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003353 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003354 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3355 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3356 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003357 else
3358 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3359 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3360 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003361 }
3362
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003363 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3364 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3365 // for some X and L2 does not.
3366 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003367 !ICS1.isBad() &&
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003368 ICS1.isListInitializationSequence() &&
3369 ICS2.isListInitializationSequence()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003370 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3371 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3372 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3373 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3374 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3375 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003376 }
3377
3378 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003379}
3380
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003381static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3382 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3383 Qualifiers Quals;
3384 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003385 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003386 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003387
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003388 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3389}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003390
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003391// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3392// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3393static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3394compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3395 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3396 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3397 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3398 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3399
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003400 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003401 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003402 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3403 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3404 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3405 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003406
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003407 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3408 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3409 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3410 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3411 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3412 else
3413 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003414 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003415 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3416
3417 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3418 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3419 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3420 }
3421
3422 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3423 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3424 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3425 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3426
3427 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3428 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3429 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3430 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003431
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003432 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3433}
3434
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003435/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3436/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3437static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3438 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3439 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3440 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3441 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003442 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003443 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003444 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003445 // reference*.
3446 //
3447 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3448 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3449 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3450 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3451 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003452 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3453 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3454 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003455
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003456 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3457 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3458 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3459 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3460}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003461
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003462/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3463/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3464/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003465static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3466CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3467 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3468 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003469{
3470 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3471 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3472
3473 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3474 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3475 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3476 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3477 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003478 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003479 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003480 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003481
3482 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3483 // defined below), or, if not that,
3484 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3485 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3486 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3487 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3488 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3489 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003490
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003491 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3492 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3493 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003494
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003495 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3496 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3497 // that is such a conversion.
3498 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3499 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3500 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3501 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3502
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003503 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3504 //
3505 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003506 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3507 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3508 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003509 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003510 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003511 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003512 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003513 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3514 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3515 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003516 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3517 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003518 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3519 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3520 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003521 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003522 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003523 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003524 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3525 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003526 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3527 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3528 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003529 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3530 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003531
3532 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3533 // conversion, if we need to.
3534 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003535 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003536 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003537 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003538
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003539 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3540 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003541
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003542 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003543 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003544 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003545 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3546
3547 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3548 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003549 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3550 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3551 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3552 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3553 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3554 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3555 FromObjCPtr2);
3556 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3557 FromObjCPtr1);
3558 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3559 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3560 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3561 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003562 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003563 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003564
3565 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3566 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003567 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003568 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003569 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003570
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003571 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003572 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3573 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3574 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3575 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3576 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003577
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003578 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3579 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3580 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3581 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3582 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3583 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003584 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3585 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003586 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3587 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003588 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003589 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3590 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003591 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003592 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3593 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3594 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3595 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3596 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3597 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3598 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3599 }
3600
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003601 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3602 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003603 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003604 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003605 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003606 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003607 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3608 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3609 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003610 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003611 }
3612 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003613
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003614 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3615 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3616 // is between types of the same size.
3617 // For example:
3618 // void f(float);
3619 // void f(int);
3620 // int main {
3621 // long a;
3622 // f(a);
3623 // }
3624 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3625 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003626 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003627 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3628 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3629 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3630 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3631 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3632
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003633 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3634}
3635
3636/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3637/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003638/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3639ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003640CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3641 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3642 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003643 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003644 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3645 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3646 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3647 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3648 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3649 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3650 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3652
3653 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3654 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003655 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3656 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003657 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3658 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003659 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003660 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3661 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003662
3663 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3664 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003665 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003666 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3667
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003668 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3669 // for comparison.
3670 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003671 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003672 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003673 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003674
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003675 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003676 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003677
3678 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3679 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3680 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3681 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3682 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3683 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3684 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3685 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3686 }
3687
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003688 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003689 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3690 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3691 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003692 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003693 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3694 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3695 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3696 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3697 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3698 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3699 // about how the sequences rank.
3700 ;
3701 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3702 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3703 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3704 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3705 // qualifiers.
3706 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003707
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003708 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3709 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3710 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3711 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3712 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3713 // qualifiers.
3714 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003715
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003716 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3717 } else {
3718 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3719 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3720 }
3721
3722 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003723 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003724 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003725 }
3726
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003727 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3728 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3729 switch (Result) {
3730 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003731 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003732 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3733 break;
3734
3735 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3736 break;
3737
3738 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003739 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003740 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3741 break;
3742 }
3743
3744 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003745}
3746
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003747/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3748/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003749/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3750/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3751/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003752ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003753CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3754 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3755 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003756 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003757 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003758 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003759 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003760
3761 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3762 // conversion, if we need to.
3763 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003764 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003765 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003766 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003767
3768 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003769 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3770 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3771 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3772 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003773
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003774 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003775 //
3776 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3777 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003778 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003779 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003780 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003781 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3782 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3783 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3784 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003785 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003786 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003787 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003788 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003789 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003790 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003791 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003792 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003793
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003794 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003795 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003796 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003797 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003798 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003799 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3800 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003801
3802 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3803 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003804 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003805 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003806 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003807 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003808 }
3809 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3810 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3811 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3812 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3813 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3814 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3815 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3816 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3817 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3818 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3819
3820 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3821 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3822 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3823 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3824 // Objective-C pointer types.
3825 bool FromAssignLeft
3826 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3827 bool FromAssignRight
3828 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3829 bool ToAssignLeft
3830 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3831 bool ToAssignRight
3832 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3833
3834 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3835 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3836 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3837 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3838 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3839 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3840 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3841 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3842
3843 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3844 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3845 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3846 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3847 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3848 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3849
3850 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3851 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3852 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3853 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3854 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3855 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3856 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3857 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3858
3859 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3860 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3861 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3863 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3864 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003865
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003866 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3867 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3868 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3869 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3870 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3871 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3872
3873 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3874 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3875 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3876 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3877 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003878 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003879 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003880
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003881 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003882 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3883 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3884 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003885 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003886 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003887 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003888 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003889 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003890 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003891 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003892 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3893 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3894 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3895 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3896 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3897 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3898 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3899 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3900 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003901 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003902 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003903 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003904 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003905 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003906 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3907 }
3908 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3909 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003910 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003911 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003912 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003913 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3914 }
3915 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003916
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003917 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003918 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003919 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3920 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3921 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003922 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3923 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3924 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003925 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003926 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003927 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3928 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003929
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003930 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003931 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3932 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3933 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003934 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3935 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3936 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003937 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003938 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003939 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3940 }
3941 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003942
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003943 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3944}
3945
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003946/// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3947/// C++ class.
3948static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3949 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3950 return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3951
3952 return true;
3953}
3954
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003955/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3956/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3957/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3958/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3959/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3960/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3961/// type being initialized.
3962Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3963Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3964 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003965 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003966 bool &ObjCConversion,
3967 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003968 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3969 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3970 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3971
3972 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3973 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3974 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3975 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3976 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3977
3978 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3979 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3980 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3981 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003982 DerivedToBase = false;
3983 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003984 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003985 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3986 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003987 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003988 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
3989 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003990 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003991 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3992 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3993 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3994 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003995 else
3996 return Ref_Incompatible;
3997
3998 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3999 // least).
4000
4001 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4002 // for comparison.
4003 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4004 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4005 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4006 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4007
4008 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4009 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4010 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4011 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4012 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4013 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4014 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004015 //
4016 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4017 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4018 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4019 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004020 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4021 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4022 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4023 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4024 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4025 }
4026
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004027 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004028 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004029 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004030 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4031 else
4032 return Ref_Related;
4033}
4034
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004035/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004036/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4037static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004038FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4039 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4040 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4041 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004042 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4043 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4044 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4045
4046 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004047 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4048 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4049 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4050 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4051 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004052 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4053 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4054 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4055 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4056
4057 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4058 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4059 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4060 if (ConvTemplate)
4061 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4062 else
4063 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4064
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004065 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004066 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4067 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4068 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004069
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004070 if (AllowRvalues) {
4071 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4072 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004073 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004074
4075 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4076 // functions that return lvalues.
4077 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4078 const ReferenceType *RefType
4079 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4080 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4081 continue;
4082 }
4083
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004084 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004085 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4086 DeclLoc,
4087 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4088 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4089 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004090 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004091 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004092 continue;
4093 } else {
4094 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4095 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4096 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4097
4098 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4099 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4100 if (!RefType ||
4101 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4102 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4103 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004104 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004105
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004106 if (ConvTemplate)
4107 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004108 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004109 else
4110 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004111 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004112 }
4113
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004114 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4115
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004116 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004117 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004118 case OR_Success:
4119 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4120 //
4121 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4122 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4123 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4124 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4125 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4126 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4127 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4128 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4129 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4130 return false;
4131
4132 ICS.setUserDefined();
4133 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4134 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004135 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004136 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004137 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004138 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4139 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4140 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4141 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4142 return true;
4143
4144 case OR_Ambiguous:
4145 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4146 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4147 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4148 if (Cand->Viable)
4149 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4150 return true;
4151
4152 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4153 case OR_Deleted:
4154 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4155 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4156 return false;
4157 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004158
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004159 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004160}
4161
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004162/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4163/// initialization.
4164static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004165TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004166 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4167 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004168 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004169 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4170
4171 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4172 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4173 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4174
4175 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4176 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4177
4178 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4179 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4180 // type of the resulting function.
4181 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4182 DeclAccessPair Found;
4183 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4184 false, Found))
4185 T2 = Fn->getType();
4186 }
4187
4188 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4189 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4190 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004191 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004192 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004193 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004194 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004195 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004196 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004197
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004198
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004199 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004200 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4201 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4202
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004203 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004204 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004205 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4206 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4207 //
4208 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4209 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4210 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004211 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004212 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4213 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4214 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4215 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4216 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4217 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4218 ICS.setStandard();
4219 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004220 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4221 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4222 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004223 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4224 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4225 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4226 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4227 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4228 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4229 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004230 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4231 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4232 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004233 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004234 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004235 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004236
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004237 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4238 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4239 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4240 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004241 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004242 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004243
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004244 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4245 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4246 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4247 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4248 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4249 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4250 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4251 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004252 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004253 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004254 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4255 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4256 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004257 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004258 }
4259 }
4260
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004261 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4262 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004263 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004264 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004265 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4266 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4267 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4268 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4269 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4270 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4271 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004272 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4273 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004274 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004275 return ICS;
4276
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004277 // -- If the initializer expression
4278 //
4279 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004280 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004281 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4282 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4283 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4284 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4285 ICS.setStandard();
4286 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004287 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004288 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4289 : ICK_Identity;
4290 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4291 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4292 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4293 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4294 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4295 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4296 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4297 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4298 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4299 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4300 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004301 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004302 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004303 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004304 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4305 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004306 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004307 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004308 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004309 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004310 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004311 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004312
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004313 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4314 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004315 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4316 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004317 // "cv3 T3",
4318 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004319 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004320 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004321 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004322 // class subobject).
4323 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004324 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004325 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4326 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4327 AllowExplicit)) {
4328 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4329 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4330 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4331 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004332 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004333 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4334 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4335
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004336 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004337 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004338
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004339 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4340 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4341 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4342 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4343 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4344 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4345 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4346 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4347 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4348 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4349 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4350 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004351 //
4352 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4353 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4354 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4355 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4356 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4357 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4358 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4359 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4360 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4361 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004362 }
4363
4364 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4365 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4366 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4367 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4368 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4369 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4370 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4371 return ICS;
4372
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004373 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4374 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4375 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4376 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4377 return ICS;
4378
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004379 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004380 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4381 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4382 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4383 // underlying type of the reference according to
4384 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4385 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4386 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4387 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4388 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004389 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4390 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004391 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004392 /*CStyle=*/false,
4393 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004394
4395 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4396 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4397 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004398 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4399 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4400 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004401 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004402 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004403 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004404 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4405 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4406 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4407 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4408 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4409 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4410 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4411 DeclType);
4412 return ICS;
4413 }
4414 }
4415 }
4416
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004417 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004418 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4419 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4420 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4421 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4422 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004423 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004424
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004425 return ICS;
4426}
4427
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004428static ImplicitConversionSequence
4429TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4430 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4431 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004432 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4433 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004434
4435/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4436/// initializer list From.
4437static ImplicitConversionSequence
4438TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4439 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4440 bool InOverloadResolution,
4441 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4442 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4443 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4444 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4445
4446 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4447 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004448 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004449
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004450 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004451 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004452 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004453 return Result;
4454
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004455 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4456 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4457 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4458 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4459 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004460 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004461 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004462 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004463 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004464 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004465 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004466 if (!X.isNull()) {
4467 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4468 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4469 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4470 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4471 InOverloadResolution,
4472 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4473 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4474 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4475 Result = ICS;
4476 break;
4477 }
4478 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4479 if (Result.isBad() ||
4480 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4481 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4482 Result = ICS;
4483 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004484
4485 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4486 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4487 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4488 Result.setStandard();
4489 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4490 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4491 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4492 }
4493
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004494 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004495 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004496 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004497 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004498
4499 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4500 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4501 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4502 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4503 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4504 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004505 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4506 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4507 Result = TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4508 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4509 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4510 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4511 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004512 return Result;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004513 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004514
4515 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4516 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4517 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4518 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004519 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004520 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4521 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4522 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4523 InitializedEntity Entity =
4524 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4525 /*Consumed=*/false);
4526 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4527 Result.setUserDefined();
4528 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4529 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4530 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4531 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4532
4533 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4534 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4535 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004536 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004537 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004538 return Result;
4539 }
4540
4541 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4542 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004543 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4544 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4545 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4546 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4547
4548 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4549
4550 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4551 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4552 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4553 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4554
4555 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4556
4557 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4558 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4559 // type of the resulting function.
4560 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4561 DeclAccessPair Found;
4562 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4563 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4564 T2 = Fn->getType();
4565 }
4566
4567 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4568 bool dummy1 = false;
4569 bool dummy2 = false;
4570 bool dummy3 = false;
4571 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4572 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4573 dummy2, dummy3);
4574
4575 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related)
4576 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType,
4577 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4578 SuppressUserConversions,
4579 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4580 }
4581
4582 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4583 // initializer list.
4584 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4585 InOverloadResolution,
4586 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4587 if (Result.isFailure())
4588 return Result;
4589 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4590 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4591
4592 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4593 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4594 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4595 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4596 Result.UserDefined.After;
4597 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4598 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4599 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4600 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4601 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4602 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4603 } else
4604 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4605 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004606 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004607 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004608
4609 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4610 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4611 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4612 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4613 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4614 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004615 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4616 if (NumInits == 1)
4617 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4618 SuppressUserConversions,
4619 InOverloadResolution,
4620 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4621 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4622 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4623 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4624 Result.setStandard();
4625 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004626 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4627 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004628 }
Sebastian Redl2422e822012-02-28 23:36:38 +00004629 Result.setListInitializationSequence();
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004630 return Result;
4631 }
4632
4633 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4634 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4635 return Result;
4636}
4637
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004638/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4639/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4640/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4641/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004642/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004643/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004644static ImplicitConversionSequence
4645TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004646 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004647 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004648 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4649 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004650 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4651 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4652 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4653
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004654 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004655 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004656 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4657 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004658 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004659
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004660 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4661 SuppressUserConversions,
4662 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004663 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004664 /*CStyle=*/false,
4665 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004666}
4667
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004668static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4669 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4670 Sema &S,
4671 SourceLocation Loc,
4672 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4673 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4674 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4675 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4676
4677 return !ICS.isBad();
4678}
4679
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004680/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4681/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4682/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004683static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004684TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004685 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004686 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4687 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4688 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004689 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4690 // const volatile object.
4691 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4692 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004693 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004694
4695 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4696 // to exit early.
4697 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004698
4699 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004700 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004701 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4702
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004703 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4704 // better have an lvalue.
4705 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4706 }
4707
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004708 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004709
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004710 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004711 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004712 // parameter is
4713 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004714 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4715 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4716 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004717 // ref-qualifier
4718 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004719 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004720 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4721 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004722 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004723 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004724 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4725 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4726 // non-constant references.
4727
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004728 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004729 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004730 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004731 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004732 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004733 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004734 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004735 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004736 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004737
4738 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4739 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004740 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004741 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4742 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4743 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004744 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004745 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004746 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004747 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4748 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004749 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004750 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004751
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004752 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4753 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4754 case RQ_None:
4755 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4756 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004757
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004758 case RQ_LValue:
4759 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4760 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004761 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004762 ImplicitParamType);
4763 return ICS;
4764 }
4765 break;
4766
4767 case RQ_RValue:
4768 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4769 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004770 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004771 ImplicitParamType);
4772 return ICS;
4773 }
4774 break;
4775 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004776
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004777 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004778 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004779 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4780 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004781 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004782 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004783 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4784 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004785 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004786 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004787 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4788 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4789 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004790 return ICS;
4791}
4792
4793/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4794/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4795/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004796ExprResult
4797Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004798 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004799 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004800 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004801 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004802 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004803 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004804
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004805 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004806 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004807 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4808 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004809 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004810 } else {
4811 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4812 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004813 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004814 }
4815
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004816 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4817 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004818 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004819 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4820 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004821 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4822 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4823 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4824 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4825 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4826 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004827 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004828 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4829 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4830 << From->getSourceRange();
4831 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4832 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004833 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004834 }
4835 }
4836
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004837 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004838 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004839 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004840 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004841
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004842 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4843 ExprResult FromRes =
4844 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4845 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4846 return ExprError();
4847 From = FromRes.take();
4848 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004849
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004850 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004851 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004852 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004853 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004854}
4855
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004856/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4857/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004858static ImplicitConversionSequence
4859TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00004860 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004861 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004862 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4863 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004864 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004865 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004866 /*CStyle=*/false,
4867 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004868}
4869
4870/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4871/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004872ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004873 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4874 return ExprError();
4875
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004876 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004877 if (!ICS.isBad())
4878 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004879
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004880 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004881 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004882 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004883 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004884 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004885}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004886
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004887/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4888/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4889/// is acceptable.
4890static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4891 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4892 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4893 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4894 // conversions are fine.
4895 switch (SCS.Second) {
4896 case ICK_Identity:
4897 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4898 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004899 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004900 return true;
4901
4902 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004903 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4904 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4905 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4906 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4907 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4908
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004909 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4910 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4911 return false;
4912
4913 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4914 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4915 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4916 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4917 case ICK_Qualification:
4918 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4919 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4920 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4921 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4922 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4923 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4924 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4925 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4926 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4927 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4928 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4929 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4930 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4931 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4932
4933 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4934 break;
4935 }
4936
4937 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4938}
4939
4940/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4941/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4942/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4943ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4944 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4945 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004946 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004947 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4948
4949 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4950 return ExprError();
4951
4952 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4953 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4954 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4955 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4956 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4957 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4958 // narrowing conversions.
4959 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4960 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4961 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4962 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4963 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4964 /*CStyle=*/false,
4965 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4966 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4967 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4968 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4969 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004970 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004971 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4972 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4973 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4974 break;
4975 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4976 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4977 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4978 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004979 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004980 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4981 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4982 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4983 break;
4984 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4985 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4986 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004987 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004988 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4989 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4990 return ExprError();
4991
4992 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4993 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4994 }
4995
4996 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4997 if (Result.isInvalid())
4998 return Result;
4999
5000 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5001 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005002 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005003 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5004 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005005 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5006 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5007 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5008 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5009 break;
5010
5011 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00005012 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5013 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
5014 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005015 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00005016 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005017 break;
5018
5019 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00005020 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5021 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
5022 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005023 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5024 break;
5025 }
5026
5027 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005028 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005029 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5030 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5031
Douglas Gregor484f6fa2013-04-08 23:24:07 +00005032 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005033 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5034 // the AST.
5035 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005036 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005037 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005038
5039 if (Notes.empty()) {
5040 // It's a constant expression.
5041 return Result;
5042 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005043 }
5044
5045 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5046 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5047 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5048 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5049 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005050 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005051 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5052 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5053 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5054 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005055 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005056}
5057
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005058/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5059/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5060/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5061static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5062 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5063 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5064 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5065 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5066 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005067}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005068
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005069/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5070/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5071static ImplicitConversionSequence
5072TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5073 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5074 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5075 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5076 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5077 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5078 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5079 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5080 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5081 /*CStyle=*/false,
5082 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
5083
5084 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5085 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5086 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5087 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5088 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5089 break;
5090
5091 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5092 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5093 break;
5094
5095 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5096 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5097 break;
5098 }
5099
5100 return ICS;
5101}
5102
5103/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5104/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5105ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005106 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5107 return ExprError();
5108
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005109 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005110 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5111 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005112 if (!ICS.isBad())
5113 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005114 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005115}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005116
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005117/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5118/// type of a permitted flavor.
5119static bool isIntegralOrEnumerationType(QualType T, bool AllowScopedEnum) {
5120 return AllowScopedEnum ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5121 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5122}
5123
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005124/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005125/// enumeration type.
5126///
5127/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
5128/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
5129/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5130///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005131/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5132/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005133///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005134/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005135///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005136/// \param Diagnoser Used to output any diagnostics.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005137///
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005138/// \param AllowScopedEnumerations Specifies whether conversions to scoped
5139/// enumerations should be considered.
5140///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005141/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5142/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005143ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005144Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005145 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005146 bool AllowScopedEnumerations) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005147 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5148 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005149 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005150
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005151 // Process placeholders immediately.
5152 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5153 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5154 if (result.isInvalid()) return result;
5155 From = result.take();
5156 }
5157
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005158 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
5159 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005160 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(T, AllowScopedEnumerations))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005161 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005162
5163 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5164
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005165 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005166 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
5167 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005168 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005169 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
5170 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005171 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005172 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005173
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005174 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005175 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005176 ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser;
5177 Expr *From;
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005178
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005179 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ICEConvertDiagnoser &Diagnoser, Expr *From)
5180 : TypeDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress), Diagnoser(Diagnoser), From(From) {}
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005181
5182 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005183 Diagnoser.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005184 }
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005185 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Diagnoser, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005186
5187 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005188 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005189
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005190 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5191 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
5192 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005193 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
5194 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005195 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005196
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005197 bool HadMultipleCandidates
5198 = (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005199
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005200 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
5201 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005202 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005203 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) {
5204 if (isIntegralOrEnumerationType(
5205 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
5206 AllowScopedEnumerations)) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005207 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
5208 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5209 else
5210 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5211 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005212 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005213 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005214
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005215 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5216 case 0:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005217 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005218 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5219 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5220 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005221
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005222 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5223 // conversion; use it.
5224 QualType ConvTy
5225 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5226 std::string TypeStr;
Douglas Gregor8987b232011-09-27 23:30:47 +00005227 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005228
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005229 Diagnoser.diagnoseExplicitConv(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005230 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5231 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5232 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
5233 ")");
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005234 Diagnoser.noteExplicitConv(*this, Conversion, ConvTy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005235
5236 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005237 // explicit conversion function.
5238 if (isSFINAEContext())
5239 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005240
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005241 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005242 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5243 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005244 if (Result.isInvalid())
5245 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005246 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5247 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5248 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5249 Result.get(), 0,
5250 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005251 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005252
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005253 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5254 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005255
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005256 case 1: {
5257 // Apply this conversion.
5258 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5259 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005260
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005261 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
5262 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5263 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005264 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005265 if (!Diagnoser.SuppressConversion) {
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005266 if (isSFINAEContext())
5267 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005268
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005269 Diagnoser.diagnoseConversion(*this, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5270 << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005271 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005272
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005273 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5274 HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00005275 if (Result.isInvalid())
5276 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +00005277 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5278 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5279 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
5280 Result.get(), 0,
5281 Result.get()->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005282 break;
5283 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005284
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005285 default:
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005286 if (Diagnoser.Suppress)
5287 return ExprError();
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005288
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005289 Diagnoser.diagnoseAmbiguous(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005290 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5291 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
5292 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5293 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005294 Diagnoser.noteAmbiguous(*this, Conv, ConvTy);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005295 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005296 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005297 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005298
Richard Smith282e7e62012-02-04 09:53:13 +00005299 if (!isIntegralOrEnumerationType(From->getType(), AllowScopedEnumerations) &&
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005300 !Diagnoser.Suppress) {
5301 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotInt(*this, Loc, From->getType())
5302 << From->getSourceRange();
5303 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005304
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005305 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005306}
5307
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005308/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005309/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5310/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5311/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005312///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005313/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005314/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5315/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005316void
5317Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005318 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005319 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005320 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005321 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005322 bool PartialOverloading,
5323 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005324 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005325 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005326 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005327 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005328 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005329
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005330 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005331 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5332 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5333 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5334 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5335 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005336 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5337 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5338 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005339 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005340 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005341 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005342 return;
5343 }
5344 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5345 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005346 }
5347
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005348 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005349 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005350
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005351 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005352 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005353
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005354 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
5355 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5356 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5357 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5358 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005359 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005360 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005361 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5362 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005363 return;
5364 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005365
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005366 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005367 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005368 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005369 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005370 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005371 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005372 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005373 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005374
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005375 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5376
5377 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5378 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5379 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005380 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005381 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005382 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005383 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005384 return;
5385 }
5386
5387 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5388 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5389 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5390 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5391 // exactly m parameters.
5392 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005393 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005394 // Not enough arguments.
5395 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005396 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005397 return;
5398 }
5399
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005400 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005401 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005402 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5403 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5404 Candidate.Viable = false;
5405 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5406 return;
5407 }
5408
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005409 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5410 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005411 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005412 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5413 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5414 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5415 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5416 // parameter of F.
5417 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005418 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005419 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005420 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005421 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5422 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005423 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005424 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005425 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5426 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005427 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005428 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005429 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005430 } else {
5431 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5432 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5433 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005434 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005435 }
5436 }
5437}
5438
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005439/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5440/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005441void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005442 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005443 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005444 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5445 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005446 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005447 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5448 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005449 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005450 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005451 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005452 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005453 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5454 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005455 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005456 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005457 SuppressUserConversions);
5458 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005459 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005460 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5461 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005462 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005463 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005464 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005465 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005466 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5467 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005468 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005469 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005470 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005471 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005472 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005473 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005474}
5475
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005476/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5477/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005478void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005479 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005480 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005481 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005482 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005483 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005484 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005485 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005486
5487 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5488 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005489
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005490 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5491 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5492 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005493 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5494 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005495 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005496 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005497 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005498 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005499 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005500 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005501 Args,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005502 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005503 }
5504}
5505
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005506/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5507/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5508/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5509/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5510/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5511/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005512/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005513void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005514Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005515 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005516 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005517 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005518 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005519 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005520 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005521 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005522 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005523 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5524 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005525
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005526 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5527 return;
5528
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005529 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005530 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005531
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005532 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005533 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005534 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005535 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005536 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005537 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005538 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005539
5540 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5541
5542 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5543 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5544 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005545 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005546 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005547 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005548 return;
5549 }
5550
5551 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5552 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5553 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5554 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5555 // exactly m parameters.
5556 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005557 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005558 // Not enough arguments.
5559 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005560 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005561 return;
5562 }
5563
5564 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005565
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005566 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005567 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5568 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5569 else {
5570 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5571 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005572 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005573 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5574 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005575 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005576 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005577 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005578 return;
5579 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005580 }
5581
5582 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5583 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005584 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005585 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5586 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5587 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5588 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5589 // parameter of F.
5590 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005591 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005592 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005593 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005594 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5595 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005596 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005597 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005598 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005599 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005600 break;
5601 }
5602 } else {
5603 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5604 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5605 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005606 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005607 }
5608 }
5609}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005610
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005611/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5612/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5613/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005614void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005615Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005616 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005617 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005618 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005619 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005620 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005621 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005622 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005623 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005624 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5625 return;
5626
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005627 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005628 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005629 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005630 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005631 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5632 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5633 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5634 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5635 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005636 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005637 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5638 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005639 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5640 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005641 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005642 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5643 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5644 Candidate.Viable = false;
5645 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5646 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5647 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005648 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005649 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005650 Info);
5651 return;
5652 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005653
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005654 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5655 // deduction as a candidate.
5656 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005657 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005658 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005659 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005660 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5661 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005662}
5663
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005664/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5665/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5666/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005667void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005668Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005669 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005670 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005671 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005672 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005673 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005674 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5675 return;
5676
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005677 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005678 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005679 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005680 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005681 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5682 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5683 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5684 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5685 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005686 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005687 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5688 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005689 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5690 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005691 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005692 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005693 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5694 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005695 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005696 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5697 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005698 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005699 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005700 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005701 return;
5702 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005703
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005704 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5705 // deduction as a candidate.
5706 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005707 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005708 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005709}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005710
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005711/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005713/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005714/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005715/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5716/// conversion function produces).
5717void
5718Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005719 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005720 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005721 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5722 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005723 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5724 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005725 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005726 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5727 return;
5728
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005729 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005730 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005731
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005732 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005733 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005734 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005735 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005736 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005737 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005738 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005739 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005740 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005741 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005742 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005743
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005744 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005745 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5746 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005747 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005748 //
5749 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5750 // object parameter.
5751 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5752 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5753 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5754 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5755 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005756
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005757 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005758 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5759 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005760 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005761
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005762 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005763 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005764 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005765 return;
5766 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005767
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005768 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005769 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5770 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5771 QualType FromCanon
5772 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5773 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5774 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5775 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005776 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005777 return;
5778 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005779
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005780 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5781 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5782 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5783 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5784 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5785 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5786 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5787 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005788 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005789 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005790 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5791 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005792 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005793 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005794
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005795 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5796 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005797 Candidate.Viable = false;
5798 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5799 return;
5800 }
5801
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005802 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005803
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005804 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005805 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5806 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005807 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00005808 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, MultiExprArg(), CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00005809 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005810 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005811 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005812 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005813 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5814 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005815
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005816 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005817 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5818 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005819
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005820 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
5821 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005822 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005823 // shall have exact match rank.
5824 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5825 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
5826 Candidate.Viable = false;
5827 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
5828 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005829
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005830 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
5831 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
5832 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
5833 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
5834 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005835 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00005836 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
5837 Candidate.Viable = false;
5838 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5839 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005840 break;
5841
5842 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5843 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005844 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005845 break;
5846
5847 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00005848 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005849 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
5850 }
5851}
5852
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005853/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
5854/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
5855/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
5856/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
5857/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005858void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005859Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005860 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005861 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005862 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5863 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5864 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5865 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
5866
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005867 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5868 return;
5869
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005870 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005871 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5872 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005873 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005874 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005875 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005876 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5877 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5878 Candidate.Viable = false;
5879 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5880 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5881 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005882 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005883 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005884 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005885 return;
5886 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005887
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005888 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
5889 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
5890 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005891 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005892 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005893}
5894
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005895/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
5896/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
5897/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
5898/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
5899/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
5900void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005901 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005902 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00005903 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005904 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005905 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005906 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005907 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5908 return;
5909
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005910 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005911 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005912
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005913 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005914 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005915 Candidate.Function = 0;
5916 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
5917 Candidate.Viable = true;
5918 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005919 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005920 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005921
5922 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5923 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005924 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005925 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005926 Object->Classify(Context),
5927 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005928 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005929 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005930 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005931 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005932 return;
5933 }
5934
5935 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
5936 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
5937 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005938 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005939 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00005940 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005941 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005942 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00005943 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005944 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005945 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
5946 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5947
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005948 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005949 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5950
5951 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5952 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5953 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005954 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005955 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005956 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005957 return;
5958 }
5959
5960 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
5961 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005962 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005963 // Not enough arguments.
5964 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005965 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005966 return;
5967 }
5968
5969 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5970 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005971 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005972 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5973 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5974 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5975 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5976 // parameter of F.
5977 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005978 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005979 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00005980 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005981 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5982 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005983 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005984 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005985 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005986 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005987 break;
5988 }
5989 } else {
5990 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5991 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5992 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005993 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005994 }
5995 }
5996}
5997
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005998/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5999/// member functions.
6000///
6001/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6002/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6003/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6004/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6005/// [over.match.oper]).
6006void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6007 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6008 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6009 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6010 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006011 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6012
6013 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6014 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6015 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6016 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6017 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6018 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6019 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6020 // constructed as follows:
6021 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006022
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006023 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6024 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6025 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6026 // the set of member candidates is empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006027 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006028 // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6029 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6030 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6031 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006032 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006033
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006034 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6035 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6036 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6037
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006038 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006039 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6040 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006041 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006042 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00006043 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
6044 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args + 1, NumArgs -1),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006045 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006046 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006047 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006048}
6049
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006050/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6051/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6052/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006053/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6054/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006055/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6056/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6057/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006058void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006059 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006060 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006061 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6062 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006063 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006064 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006065
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006066 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006067 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(NumArgs);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006068 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006069 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006070 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006071 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006072 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6073 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6074 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6075
6076 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6077 // arguments.
6078 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006079 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006080 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006081 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6082 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6083 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6084 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6085 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6086 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006087 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006088 //
6089 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6090 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6091 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6092 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006093 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006094 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006095 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006096 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6097 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006098 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006099 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006100 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006101 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006102 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6103 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006104 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006105 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006106 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006107 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006108 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006109 break;
6110 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006111 }
6112}
6113
6114/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6115/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6116/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6117/// enumeration types.
6118class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6119 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006120 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006121
6122 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6123 /// built-in candidates.
6124 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6125
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006126 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6127 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6128 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6129
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006130 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6131 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6132 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6133
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006134 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006135 /// candidates.
6136 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006137
6138 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6139 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6140
6141 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6142 /// were present in the candidate set.
6143 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6144
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006145 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6146 /// candidate set.
6147 bool HasNullPtrType;
6148
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006149 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6150 /// candidate type set.
6151 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006152
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006153 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6154 ASTContext &Context;
6155
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006156 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6157 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006158 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006159
6160public:
6161 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006162 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006163
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006164 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006165 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6166 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006167 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006168 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6169 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006170
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006171 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006172 SourceLocation Loc,
6173 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006174 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6175 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006176
6177 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6178 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6179
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006180 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006181 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6182
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006183 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6184 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6185
6186 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6187 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6188
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006189 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6190 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6191
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006192 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006193 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006194
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006195 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6196 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006197
6198 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6199 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006200 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006201};
6202
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006203/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006204/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6205/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6206/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6207/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6208/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6209/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006210///
6211/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006212bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006213BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6214 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006215
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006216 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006217 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006218 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006219
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006220 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006221 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006222 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006223 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006224 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6225 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6226 buildObjCPtr = true;
6227 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006228 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006229 }
6230
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006231 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6232 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6233 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6234 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6235 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6236 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006237
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006238 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006239 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6240 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006241
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006242 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6243 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6244 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006245 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006246 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006247
6248 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6249 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6250 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6251 (!hasRestrict ||
6252 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6253 continue;
6254
6255 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006256 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006257
6258 // Build qualified pointer type.
6259 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006260 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006261 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006262 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006263 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6264
6265 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6266 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006267 }
6268
6269 return true;
6270}
6271
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006272/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6273/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6274/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6275/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6276/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6277/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6278/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006279///
6280/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006281bool
6282BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6283 QualType Ty) {
6284 // Insert this type.
6285 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6286 return false;
6287
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006288 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6289 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006290
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006291 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006292 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6293 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6294 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6295 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6296 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6297 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006298 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6299
6300 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6301 // qualifiers.
6302 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6303 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6304 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006305
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006306 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006307 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6308 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006309 }
6310
6311 return true;
6312}
6313
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006314/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6315/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006316/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6317/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006318/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6319/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6320/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6321/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006322void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006323BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006324 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006325 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006326 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6327 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006328 // Only deal with canonical types.
6329 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6330
6331 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6332 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006333 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006334 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6335
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006336 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6337 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6338 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6339
6340 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006341 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006342
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006343 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6344 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6345 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6346
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006347 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6348 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6349 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6350
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006351 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6352 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6353 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006354 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6355 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006356 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006357 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006358 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6359 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6360 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6361 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006362 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006363 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006364 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006365 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006366 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6367 // extension.
6368 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006369 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006370 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6371 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006372 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6373 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6374 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6375 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006376
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006377 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006378 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6379 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6380 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6381 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6382 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006383 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6384 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6385 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006386
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006387 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6388 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6389 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6390 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006391
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006392 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6393 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6394 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6395 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006396 }
6397 }
6398 }
6399}
6400
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006401/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6402/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6403/// given type to the candidate set.
6404static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6405 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006406 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006407 unsigned NumArgs,
6408 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6409 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006410
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006411 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6412 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6413 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6414 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6415 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006416
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006417 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6418 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006419 ParamTypes[0]
6420 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006421 ParamTypes[1] = T;
6422 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006423 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006424 }
6425}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006426
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006427/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6428/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006429static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6430 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6431 const RecordType *TyRec;
6432 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6433 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006434 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006435 else
6436 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6437 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006438 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006439 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6440 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6441 return VRQuals;
6442 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006443
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006444 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006445 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6446 return VRQuals;
6447
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006448 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6449 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6450 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006451
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006452 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6453 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006454 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6455 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6456 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6457 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006458 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6459 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6460 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6461 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6462 // as see them.
6463 bool done = false;
6464 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006465 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6466 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006467 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6468 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006469 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006470 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6471 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6472 else
6473 done = true;
6474 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6475 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006476 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6477 return VRQuals;
6478 }
6479 }
6480 }
6481 return VRQuals;
6482}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006483
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006484namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006485
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006486/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6487/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6488/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6489/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6490class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006491 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6492 Sema &S;
6493 Expr **Args;
6494 unsigned NumArgs;
6495 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006496 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006497 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006498 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006499
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006500 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6501 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006502 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6503 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006504 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006505 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006506 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006507 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006508 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006509 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6510 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006511
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006512 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6513 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6514 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6515 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6516 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6517 // Start of promoted types.
6518 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6519 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6520 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006521
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006522 // Start of integral types.
6523 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6524 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6525 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006526 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006527 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6528 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6529 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006530 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006531 // End of promoted types.
6532
6533 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6534 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6535 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6536 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6537 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6538 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6539 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6540 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6541 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6542 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006543 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006544 };
6545 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6546 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006547
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006548 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6549 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6550 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6551 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6552 // The rules are basically:
6553 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6554 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6555 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6556 // - use the larger type
6557 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6558 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6559 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6560 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6561 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006562 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006563 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006564 Dep=-1,
6565 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006566 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006567 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006568 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006569/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6570/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6571/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6572/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6573/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6574/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6575/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6576/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6577/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6578/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6579/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006580 };
6581
6582 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6583 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6584 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6585
6586 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006587 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006588
6589 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6590 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006591 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6592 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006593 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6594 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6595
6596 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6597 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6598 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6599
6600 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6601 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6602 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6603 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6604 }
6605
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006606 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6607 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006608 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006609 bool HasVolatile,
6610 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006611 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6612 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6613 S.Context.IntTy
6614 };
6615
6616 // Non-volatile version.
6617 if (NumArgs == 1)
6618 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6619 else
6620 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6621
6622 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6623 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6624 if (HasVolatile) {
6625 ParamTypes[0] =
6626 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6627 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
6628 if (NumArgs == 1)
6629 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6630 else
6631 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6632 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006633
6634 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6635 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6636 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6637 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6638 ParamTypes[0]
6639 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6640 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
6641 if (NumArgs == 1)
6642 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6643 else
6644 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6645
6646 if (HasVolatile) {
6647 ParamTypes[0]
6648 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6649 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6650 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6651 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
6652 if (NumArgs == 1)
6653 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1,
6654 CandidateSet);
6655 else
6656 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6657 }
6658 }
6659
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006660 }
6661
6662public:
6663 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
6664 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6665 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006666 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006667 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006668 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
6669 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
6670 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006671 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6672 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006673 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6674 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6675 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006676 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006677 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006678 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006679 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006680 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006681 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6682 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006683 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006684 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006685 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006686 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6687 }
6688
6689 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6690 //
6691 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6692 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6693 // functions of the form
6694 //
6695 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6696 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6697 //
6698 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6699 //
6700 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6701 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6702 // candidate operator functions of the form
6703 //
6704 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6705 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6706 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006707 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6708 return;
6709
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006710 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6711 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6712 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006713 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006714 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6715 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006716 }
6717 }
6718
6719 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6720 //
6721 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6722 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6723 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6724 //
6725 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6726 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6727 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6728 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6729 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6730 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6731 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6732 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6733 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6734 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006735 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006736 continue;
6737
6738 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006739 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6740 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6741 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6742 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006743 }
6744 }
6745
6746 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6747 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6748 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6749 //
6750 // T& operator*(T*);
6751 //
6752 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006753 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006754 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006755 // T& operator*(T*);
6756 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6757 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6758 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6759 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6760 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6761 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6762 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006763 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6764 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006765
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006766 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6767 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6768 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006769
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006770 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
6771 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6772 }
6773 }
6774
6775 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6776 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6777 // operator functions of the form
6778 //
6779 // T operator+(T);
6780 // T operator-(T);
6781 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006782 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6783 return;
6784
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006785 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6786 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006787 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006788 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6789 }
6790
6791 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6792 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6793 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6794 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6795 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6796 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6797 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6798 }
6799 }
6800
6801 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6802 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6803 // the form
6804 //
6805 // T* operator+(T*);
6806 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
6807 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6808 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6809 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6810 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6811 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6812 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6813 }
6814 }
6815
6816 // C++ [over.built]p10:
6817 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
6818 // operator functions of the form
6819 //
6820 // T operator~(T);
6821 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006822 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6823 return;
6824
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006825 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6826 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006827 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006828 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6829 }
6830
6831 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
6832 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6833 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6834 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6835 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6836 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
6837 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
6838 }
6839 }
6840
6841 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
6842 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
6843 // functions of the form
6844 //
6845 // bool operator==(T,T);
6846 // bool operator!=(T,T);
6847 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
6848 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6849 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6850
6851 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6852 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6853 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6854 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6855 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
6856 ++MemPtr) {
6857 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6858 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6859 continue;
6860
6861 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6862 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6863 CandidateSet);
6864 }
6865 }
6866 }
6867
6868 // C++ [over.built]p15:
6869 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006870 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
6871 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006872 //
6873 // bool operator<(T, T);
6874 // bool operator>(T, T);
6875 // bool operator<=(T, T);
6876 // bool operator>=(T, T);
6877 // bool operator==(T, T);
6878 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006879 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006880 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6881 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
6882 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
6883 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
6884 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006885 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006886 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
6887 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
6888 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
6889 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006890 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
6891 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
6892 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
6893 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
6894
6895 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6896 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
6897 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
6898 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
6899 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6900 C != CEnd; ++C) {
6901 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
6902 continue;
6903
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00006904 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
6905 continue;
6906
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006907 QualType FirstParamType =
6908 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6909 QualType SecondParamType =
6910 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6911
6912 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
6913 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
6914 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
6915 continue;
6916
6917 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
6918 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
6919 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
6920 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
6921 }
6922 }
6923 }
6924
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006925 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6926 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6927
6928 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6929 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6930 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6931 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6932 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6933 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
6934 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6935 continue;
6936
6937 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6938 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6939 CandidateSet);
6940 }
6941 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6942 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6943 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6944 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6945 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
6946
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006947 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
6948 // candidate exists.
6949 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
6950 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
6951 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006952 continue;
6953
6954 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006955 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6956 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006957 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006958
6959 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
6960 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
6961 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
6962 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
6963 NullPtrTy))) {
6964 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
6965 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6966 CandidateSet);
6967 }
6968 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006969 }
6970 }
6971
6972 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6973 //
6974 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
6975 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6976 //
6977 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6978 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
6979 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
6980 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
6981 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
6982 //
6983 // C++ [over.built]p14:
6984 //
6985 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
6986 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6987 //
6988 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6989 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6990 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6991 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6992
6993 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
6994 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
6995 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6996 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6997 };
6998 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6999 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7000 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7001 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007002 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7003 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7004 continue;
7005
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007006 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7007 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7008 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7009 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7010 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
7011 CandidateSet);
7012 }
7013 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7014 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7015 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7016 continue;
7017
7018 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7019 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
7020 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7021 }
7022 }
7023 }
7024 }
7025
7026 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7027 //
7028 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7029 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7030 //
7031 // LR operator*(L, R);
7032 // LR operator/(L, R);
7033 // LR operator+(L, R);
7034 // LR operator-(L, R);
7035 // bool operator<(L, R);
7036 // bool operator>(L, R);
7037 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7038 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7039 // bool operator==(L, R);
7040 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7041 //
7042 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7043 // between types L and R.
7044 //
7045 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7046 //
7047 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7048 // candidate operator functions of the form
7049 //
7050 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7051 //
7052 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7053 // between types L and R.
7054 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7055 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007056 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7057 return;
7058
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007059 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7060 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7061 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7062 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007063 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7064 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007065 QualType Result =
7066 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007067 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007068 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7069 }
7070 }
7071
7072 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7073 // conditional operator for vector types.
7074 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7075 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7076 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7077 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7078 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7079 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7080 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7081 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7082 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7083 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7084 if (!isComparison) {
7085 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7086 Result = *Vec1;
7087 else
7088 Result = *Vec2;
7089 }
7090
7091 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7092 }
7093 }
7094 }
7095
7096 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7097 //
7098 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7099 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7100 //
7101 // LR operator%(L, R);
7102 // LR operator&(L, R);
7103 // LR operator^(L, R);
7104 // LR operator|(L, R);
7105 // L operator<<(L, R);
7106 // L operator>>(L, R);
7107 //
7108 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7109 // between types L and R.
7110 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007111 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7112 return;
7113
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007114 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7115 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7116 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7117 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007118 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7119 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007120 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7121 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007122 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007123 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7124 }
7125 }
7126 }
7127
7128 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7129 //
7130 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7131 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7132 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7133 //
7134 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7135 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7136 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7137 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7138
7139 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7140 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7141 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7142 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7143 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7144 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7145 continue;
7146
7147 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
7148 CandidateSet);
7149 }
7150
7151 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7152 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7153 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7154 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7155 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7156 continue;
7157
7158 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
7159 CandidateSet);
7160 }
7161 }
7162 }
7163
7164 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7165 //
7166 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7167 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7168 // of the form
7169 //
7170 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7171 //
7172 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7173 //
7174 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7175 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7176 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7177 //
7178 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7179 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7180 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7181 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7182 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7183
7184 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7185 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7186 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7187 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7188 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7189 if (isEqualOp)
7190 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007191 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7192 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007193
7194 // non-volatile version
7195 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7196 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7197 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7198 };
7199 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7200 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7201
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007202 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7203 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7204 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007205 // volatile version
7206 ParamTypes[0] =
7207 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7208 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7209 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7210 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007211
7212 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7213 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7214 // restrict version
7215 ParamTypes[0]
7216 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7217 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7218 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7219
7220 if (NeedVolatile) {
7221 // volatile restrict version
7222 ParamTypes[0]
7223 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7224 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7225 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7226 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7227 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7228 CandidateSet,
7229 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7230 }
7231 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007232 }
7233
7234 if (isEqualOp) {
7235 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7236 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7237 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7238 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7239 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7240 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7241 continue;
7242
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007243 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7244 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7245 *Ptr,
7246 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007247
7248 // non-volatile version
7249 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7250 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7251
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007252 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7253 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7254 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007255 // volatile version
7256 ParamTypes[0] =
7257 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007258 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7259 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007260 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007261
7262 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7263 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7264 // restrict version
7265 ParamTypes[0]
7266 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7267 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7268 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7269
7270 if (NeedVolatile) {
7271 // volatile restrict version
7272 ParamTypes[0]
7273 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7274 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7275 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7276 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7277 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7278 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7279
7280 }
7281 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007282 }
7283 }
7284 }
7285
7286 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7287 //
7288 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7289 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7290 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7291 // the form
7292 //
7293 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7294 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7295 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7296 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7297 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7298 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007299 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7300 return;
7301
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007302 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7303 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7304 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7305 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007306 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007307
7308 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7309 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007310 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007311 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7312 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7313
7314 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7315 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7316 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007317 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007318 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007319 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7320 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007321 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7322 }
7323 }
7324 }
7325
7326 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7327 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7328 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7329 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7330 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7331 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7332 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7333 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7334 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7335 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7336 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7337 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7338 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7339 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7340 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7341
7342 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7343 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7344 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7345 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007346 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7347 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007348 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7349 }
7350 }
7351 }
7352 }
7353
7354 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7355 //
7356 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7357 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7358 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7359 //
7360 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7361 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7362 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7363 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7364 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7365 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7366 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007367 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7368 return;
7369
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007370 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7371 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7372 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7373 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007374 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007375
7376 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7377 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007378 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007379 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7380 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7381 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007382 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007383 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7384 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7385 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
7386 CandidateSet);
7387 }
7388 }
7389 }
7390 }
7391
7392 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7393 //
7394 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7395 //
7396 // bool operator!(bool);
7397 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7398 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7399 void addExclaimOverload() {
7400 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
7401 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
7402 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7403 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7404 }
7405 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7406 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
7407 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
7408 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7409 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7410 }
7411
7412 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7413 //
7414 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7415 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7416 //
7417 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7418 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7419 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7420 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7421 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7422 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7423 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7424 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7425 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7426 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7427 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7428 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007429 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7430 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007431
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007432 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7433
7434 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
7435 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7436 }
7437
7438 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7439 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7440 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7441 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7442 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7443 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007444 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7445 continue;
7446
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007447 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7448
7449 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
7450 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7451 }
7452 }
7453
7454 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7455 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7456 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7457 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7458 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7459 //
7460 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7461 //
7462 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7463 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7464 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7465 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7466 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7467 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7468 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7469 QualType C1;
7470 QualifierCollector Q1;
7471 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7472 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7473 continue;
7474 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7475 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7476 // volatile/restrict type.
7477 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7478 continue;
7479 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7480 continue;
7481 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7482 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7483 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7484 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7485 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7486 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7487 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7488 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7489 break;
7490 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7491 // build CV12 T&
7492 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7493 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7494 T.isVolatileQualified())
7495 continue;
7496 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7497 T.isRestrictQualified())
7498 continue;
7499 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7500 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7501 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7502 }
7503 }
7504 }
7505
7506 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7507 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7508 // therefore added as binary.
7509 //
7510 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7511 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7512 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7513 //
7514 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7515 //
7516 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7517 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7518 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7519
7520 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7521 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7522 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7523 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7524 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7525 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7526 continue;
7527
7528 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7529 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7530 }
7531
7532 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7533 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7534 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7535 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7536 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7537 continue;
7538
7539 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7540 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7541 }
7542
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007543 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007544 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7545 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7546 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7547 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7548 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7549 continue;
7550
7551 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7552 continue;
7553
7554 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7555 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7556 }
7557 }
7558 }
7559 }
7560};
7561
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007562} // end anonymous namespace
7563
7564/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7565/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7566/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7567/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7568/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
7569void
7570Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7571 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7572 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7573 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007574 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7575 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007576 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7577 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007578 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7579 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007580 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7581 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007582
7583 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7584 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007585 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007586 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7587 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7588 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7589 OpLoc,
7590 true,
7591 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7592 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7593 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7594 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007595 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7596 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7597 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7598 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7599 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007600 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007601
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007602 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7603 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007604 //
7605 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7606 // 'bool' overloads.
7607 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
7608 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007609 return;
7610
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007611 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
7612 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
7613 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007614 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007615 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7616
7617 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007618 switch (Op) {
7619 case OO_None:
7620 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007621 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007622
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007623 case OO_New:
7624 case OO_Delete:
7625 case OO_Array_New:
7626 case OO_Array_Delete:
7627 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007628 llvm_unreachable(
7629 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007630
7631 case OO_Comma:
7632 case OO_Arrow:
7633 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7634 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7635 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007636 break;
7637
7638 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007639 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007640 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007641 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007642
7643 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007644 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007645 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007646 } else {
7647 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7648 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7649 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007650 break;
7651
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007652 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007653 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007654 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7655 else
7656 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7657 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007658
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007659 case OO_Slash:
7660 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007661 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007662
7663 case OO_PlusPlus:
7664 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007665 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7666 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007667 break;
7668
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007669 case OO_EqualEqual:
7670 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007671 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007672 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007673
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007674 case OO_Less:
7675 case OO_Greater:
7676 case OO_LessEqual:
7677 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007678 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007679 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7680 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007681
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007682 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007683 case OO_Caret:
7684 case OO_Pipe:
7685 case OO_LessLess:
7686 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007687 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007688 break;
7689
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007690 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
7691 if (NumArgs == 1)
7692 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7693 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7694 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7695 break;
7696
7697 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7698 break;
7699
7700 case OO_Tilde:
7701 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7702 break;
7703
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007704 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007705 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007706 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007707
7708 case OO_PlusEqual:
7709 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007710 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007711 // Fall through.
7712
7713 case OO_StarEqual:
7714 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007715 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007716 break;
7717
7718 case OO_PercentEqual:
7719 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7720 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7721 case OO_AmpEqual:
7722 case OO_CaretEqual:
7723 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007724 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007725 break;
7726
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007727 case OO_Exclaim:
7728 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007729 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007730
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007731 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007732 case OO_PipePipe:
7733 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007734 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007735
7736 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007737 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007738 break;
7739
7740 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007741 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007742 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007743
7744 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007745 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007746 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7747 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007748 }
7749}
7750
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007751/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7752/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7753///
7754/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7755/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7756/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7757/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007758void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007759Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007760 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007761 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007762 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007763 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007764 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007765 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007766
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007767 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7768 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7769 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7770 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7771 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7772 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7773
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007774 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007775 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007776
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007777 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007778 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7779 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7780 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007781 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007782 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007783 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007784 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007785 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007786
7787 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7788 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007789 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007790 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007791 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007792 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007793 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007794
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007795 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7796 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007797 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007798 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007799 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007800 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007801 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007802}
7803
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007804/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7805/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007806bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007807isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007808 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7809 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007810 SourceLocation Loc,
7811 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007812 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7813 // functions.
7814 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7815 return Cand1.Viable;
7816 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
7817 return false;
7818
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007819 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
7820 //
7821 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
7822 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
7823 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
7824 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
7825 unsigned StartArg = 0;
7826 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
7827 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007828
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007829 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007830 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
7831 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007832 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00007833 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
7834 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007835 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007836 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007837 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7838 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007839 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
7840 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7841 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7842 HasBetterConversion = true;
7843 break;
7844
7845 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7846 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7847 return false;
7848
7849 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7850 // Do nothing.
7851 break;
7852 }
7853 }
7854
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007855 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007856 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007857 if (HasBetterConversion)
7858 return true;
7859
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007860 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007861 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00007862 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007863 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
7864 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007865
7866 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
7867 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
7868 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00007869 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00007870 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007871 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007872 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007873 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7874 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
7875 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007876 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00007877 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007878 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007879 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00007880 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007881
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007882 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
7883 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
7884 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
7885 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
7886 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
7887 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007888 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007889 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007890 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00007891 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
7892 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
7893 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
7894 // pointer or block.
7895 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
7896 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
7897 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
7898 return FuncResult;
7899
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007900 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
7901 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00007902 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
7903 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7904 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
7905 return true;
7906
7907 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7908 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
7909 return false;
7910
7911 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7912 // Do nothing
7913 break;
7914 }
7915 }
7916
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007917 return false;
7918}
7919
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007920/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007921/// within an overload candidate set.
7922///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007923/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007924/// which overload resolution occurs.
7925///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00007926/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
7927/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007928///
7929/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007930OverloadingResult
7931OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007932 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007933 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007934 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007935 Best = end();
7936 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
7937 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007938 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007939 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007940 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007941 }
7942
7943 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007944 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007945 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
7946
7947 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
7948 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007949 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007950 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007951 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007952 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007953 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007954 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007955 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007956 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007957 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007958
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007959 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007960 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007961 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
7962 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007963 return OR_Deleted;
7964
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007965 return OR_Success;
7966}
7967
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007968namespace {
7969
7970enum OverloadCandidateKind {
7971 oc_function,
7972 oc_method,
7973 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007974 oc_function_template,
7975 oc_method_template,
7976 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007977 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
7978 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007979 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007980 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00007981 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007982 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007983};
7984
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007985OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
7986 FunctionDecl *Fn,
7987 std::string &Description) {
7988 bool isTemplate = false;
7989
7990 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
7991 isTemplate = true;
7992 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7993 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
7994 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007995
7996 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007997 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007998 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00007999
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008000 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8001 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8002
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008003 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8004 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8005
8006 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8007 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8008
8009 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8010 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8011 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008012 }
8013
8014 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8015 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8016 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008017 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008018 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008019
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008020 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8021 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8022
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008023 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8024 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8025
8026 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8027 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008028 }
8029
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008030 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008031}
8032
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008033void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
8034 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8035 if (!Ctor) return;
8036
8037 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8038 if (!Ctor) return;
8039
8040 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8041}
8042
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008043} // end anonymous namespace
8044
8045// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008046void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008047 std::string FnDesc;
8048 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008049 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8050 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8051 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8052 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008053 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008054}
8055
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008056//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8057// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008058void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008059 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8060
8061 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8062 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8063
8064 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8065 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8066 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8067 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8068 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008069 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008070 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8071 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008072 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008073 }
8074 }
8075}
8076
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008077/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8078/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8079/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008080void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8081 Sema &S,
8082 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8083 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8084 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8085 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008086 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8087 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8088 // refactoring here.
8089 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8090 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8091 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8092 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8093 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8094 break;
8095 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008096 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008097 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008098 if (I != E)
8099 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008100}
8101
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008102namespace {
8103
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008104void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8105 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8106 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008107 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8108 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8109
8110 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8111 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8112 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008113 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008114 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008115 if (I == 0)
8116 isObjectArgument = true;
8117 else
8118 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008119 }
8120
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008121 std::string FnDesc;
8122 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8123
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008124 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8125 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8126 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008127
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008128 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008129 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008130 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8131 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8132 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008133 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008134
8135 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8136 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8137 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8138 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008139 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008140 return;
8141 }
8142
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008143 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8144 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008145 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8146 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8147 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8148 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8149 else {
8150 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8151 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8152 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8153 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8154 }
8155
8156 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8157 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008158 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8159 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8160
8161 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8162 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8163 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8164 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8165 << FromTy
8166 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8167 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008168 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008169 return;
8170 }
8171
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008172 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008173 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008174 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8175 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8176 << FromTy
8177 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8178 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8179 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8180 return;
8181 }
8182
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008183 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8184 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8185 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8186 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8187 << FromTy
8188 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8189 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8190 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8191 return;
8192 }
8193
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008194 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8195 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8196
8197 if (isObjectArgument) {
8198 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8199 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8200 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8201 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8202 } else {
8203 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8204 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8205 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8206 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8207 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008208 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008209 return;
8210 }
8211
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008212 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8213 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8214 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8215 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8216 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8217 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8218 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8219 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8220 return;
8221 }
8222
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008223 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8224 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8225 // the failure.
8226 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8227 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8228 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8229 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8230 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8231 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8232 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8233 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008234 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008235 return;
8236 }
8237
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008238 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008239 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008240 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8241 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8242 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8243 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8244 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8245 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008246 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008247 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008248 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008249 }
8250 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8251 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8252 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8253 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8254 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8255 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8256 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8257 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8258 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008259 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8260 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008261 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8262 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8263 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8264 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8265 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8266 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8267 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8268 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008269 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8270 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8271 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8272 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8273 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8274 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008275 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008276 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008277
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008278 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008279 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008280 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008281 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8282 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008283 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008284 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008285 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008286 return;
8287 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008288
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008289 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8290 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8291 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8292 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8293 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8294 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8295 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8296 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8297 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8298 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8299 return;
8300 }
8301 }
8302
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008303 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8304 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8305 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008306 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008307 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8308 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8309
8310 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008311 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8312 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008313 FDiag << *HI;
8314 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8315
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008316 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008317}
8318
8319void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8320 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8321 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8322
8323 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8324 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8325
8326 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008327
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008328 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
8329 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
8330 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8331 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8332 // Just don't report anything.
8333 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8334 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
8335 return;
8336
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008337 // at least / at most / exactly
8338 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8339 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008340 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8341 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8342 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008343 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008344 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008345 mode = 0; // "at least"
8346 else
8347 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8348 modeCount = MinParams;
8349 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008350 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8351 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8352 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008353 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8354 mode = 1; // "at most"
8355 else
8356 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8357 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8358 }
8359
8360 std::string Description;
8361 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8362
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008363 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8364 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8365 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8366 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8367 else
8368 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8369 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8370 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008371 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008372}
8373
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008374/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8375void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008376 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008377 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
8378
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008379 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008380 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8381 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8382 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8383 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008384 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
8385 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8386 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8387
8388 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008389 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
8390 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8391 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008392 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008393 return;
8394 }
8395
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008396 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8397 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8398 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8399
8400 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
8401
8402 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8403 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008404 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008405 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008406 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008407 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8408
8409 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8410 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8411 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8412 // done on dependent types).
8413 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
8414
8415 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8416 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008417 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008418 return;
8419 }
8420
8421 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008422 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008423 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008424 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008425 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008426 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008427 which = 1;
8428 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008429 which = 2;
8430 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008431
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008432 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008433 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008434 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8435 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008436 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008437 return;
8438 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008439
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008440 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008441 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008442 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008443 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008444 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
8445 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8446 else {
8447 int index = 0;
8448 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8449 index = TTP->getIndex();
8450 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8451 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8452 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8453 else
8454 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008455 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008456 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
8457 << (index + 1);
8458 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008459 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008460 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008461
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008462 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8463 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8464 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
8465 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008466
8467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8468 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008469 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008470 return;
8471
8472 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008473 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008474 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008475 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
8476 Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
8477 TemplateArgString = " ";
8478 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8479 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
8480 }
8481
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008482 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
8483 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
8484 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8485 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8486 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8487 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8488 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8489 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8490 return;
8491 }
8492
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008493 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8494 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8495 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008496 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008497 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008498 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008499 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8500 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8501 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8502 }
8503
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008504 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008505 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008506 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008507 return;
8508 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008509
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008510 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
8511 OverloadExpr::FindResult R =
8512 OverloadExpr::find(Cand->DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8513 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8514 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
8515 << R.Expression->getName();
8516 return;
8517 }
8518
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008519 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008520 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008521 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
8522 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8523 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
8524 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
8525 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
8526 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
8527 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
8528 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
8529 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
8530 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
8531 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
8532 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since:
8533 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
8534 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
8535 // name for types, not decls.
8536 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
8537 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
8538 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
8539 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
8540 return;
8541 }
8542 }
8543 }
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008544 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008545 << FirstTA << SecondTA;
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008546 return;
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008547 }
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008548 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8549 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008550 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008551 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008552 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008553 return;
8554 }
8555}
8556
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008557/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8558void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8559 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8560 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8561
8562 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8563 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8564
8565 std::string FnDesc;
8566 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8567
8568 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8569 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8570}
8571
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008572/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8573/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8574///
8575/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8576/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8577/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8578/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8579/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8580/// overload.
8581///
8582/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8583/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8584/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008585void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008586 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008587 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8588
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008589 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008590 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8591 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008592 std::string FnDesc;
8593 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008594
8595 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008596 << FnKind << FnDesc
8597 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008598 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008599 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008600 }
8601
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008602 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8603 if (Cand->Viable) {
8604 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8605 return;
8606 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008607
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008608 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8609 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8610 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8611 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008612
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008613 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008614 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008615
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008616 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8617 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008618 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008619 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008620
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008621 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8622 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008623 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008624 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8625 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008626
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008627 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8628 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8629 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8630 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008631 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008632
8633 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8634 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008635 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008636}
8637
8638void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8639 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8640 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8641 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8642 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8643 bool isLValueReference = false;
8644 bool isRValueReference = false;
8645 bool isPointer = false;
8646 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8647 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8648 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8649 isLValueReference = true;
8650 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8651 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8652 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8653 isRValueReference = true;
8654 }
8655 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8656 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8657 isPointer = true;
8658 }
8659 // Desugar down to a function type.
8660 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8661 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8662 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8663 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8664 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8665
8666 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8667 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008668 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008669}
8670
8671void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008672 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008673 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8674 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008675 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008676 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8677 TypeStr += Opc;
8678 TypeStr += "(";
8679 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008680 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008681 TypeStr += ")";
8682 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8683 } else {
8684 TypeStr += ", ";
8685 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8686 TypeStr += ")";
8687 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8688 }
8689}
8690
8691void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8692 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008693 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008694 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8695 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008696 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8697 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8698
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008699 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008700 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008701 }
8702}
8703
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008704SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8705 if (Cand->Function)
8706 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008707 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008708 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8709 return SourceLocation();
8710}
8711
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008712static unsigned
8713RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008714 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008715 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008716 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008717
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008718 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008719 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8720 return 1;
8721
8722 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8723 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8724 return 2;
8725
8726 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8727 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008728 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008729 return 3;
8730
8731 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8732 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8733 return 4;
8734
8735 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8736 return 5;
8737
8738 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8739 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8740 return 6;
8741 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008742 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008743}
8744
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008745struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8746 Sema &S;
8747 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008748
8749 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8750 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008751 // Fast-path this check.
8752 if (L == R) return false;
8753
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008754 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008755 if (L->Viable) {
8756 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8757
8758 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8759 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8760 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008761 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8762 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008763 } else if (R->Viable)
8764 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008765
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008766 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008767
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008768 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
8769 if (!L->Viable) {
8770 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
8771 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8772 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8773 return false;
8774 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
8775 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
8776 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008777
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008778 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
8779 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
8780 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
8781 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8782 return true;
8783
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008784 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
8785 // comes first.
8786 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8787 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
8788 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
8789 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008790 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008791 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
8792 return true;
8793 else
8794 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00008795 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008796
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008797 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
8798 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008799 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008800
8801 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00008802 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008803 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008804 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8805 L->Conversions[I],
8806 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008807 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8808 leftBetter++;
8809 break;
8810
8811 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8812 leftBetter--;
8813 break;
8814
8815 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8816 break;
8817 }
8818 }
8819 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
8820 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
8821
8822 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
8823 return false;
8824
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008825 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
8826 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8827 return true;
8828
8829 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
8830 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00008831 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00008832 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
8833 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008834
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008835 // TODO: others?
8836 }
8837
8838 // Sort everything else by location.
8839 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
8840 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
8841
8842 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
8843 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
8844 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
8845
8846 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008847 }
8848};
8849
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008850/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008851/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008852void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008853 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008854 assert(!Cand->Viable);
8855
8856 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
8857 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
8858
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008859 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
8860 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008861 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
8862 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008863
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008864 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008865 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008866 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008867 while (true) {
8868 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
8869 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008870 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008871 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008872 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008873 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008874 }
8875
8876 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
8877 return;
8878
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008879 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
8880 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
8881
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00008882 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008883 // operation somehow.
8884 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008885
8886 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
8887 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
8888
8889 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
8890 QualType ConvType
8891 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8892 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8893 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
8894 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8895 ArgIdx--;
8896 } else if (Cand->Function) {
8897 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8898 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
8899 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
8900 ArgIdx--;
8901 } else {
8902 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
8903 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
8904 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
8905 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008906 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
8907 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008908 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008909 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
8910 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008911 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008912 return;
8913 }
8914
8915 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
8916 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8917 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008918 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008919 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00008920 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008921 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008922 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
8923 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00008924 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008925 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
8926 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00008927 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008928 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008929 else
8930 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
8931 }
8932}
8933
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008934} // end anonymous namespace
8935
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008936/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
8937/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008938/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008939void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
8940 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008941 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008942 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008943 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008944 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
8945 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008946 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008947 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
8948 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008949 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008950 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008951 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008952 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008953 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
8954 Cands.push_back(Cand);
8955 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
8956 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008957 }
8958 }
8959
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008960 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008961 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008962
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008963 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008964
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00008965 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008966 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008967 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008968 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8969 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00008970
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008971 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
8972 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
8973 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00008974 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008975 break;
8976 }
8977 ++CandsShown;
8978
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008979 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008980 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008981 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008982 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00008983 else {
8984 assert(Cand->Viable &&
8985 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008986 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
8987 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
8988 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
8989 //
8990 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
8991 // different ambiguities, though.
8992 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008993 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008994 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
8995 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008996
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008997 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008998 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00008999 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009000 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009001
9002 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009003 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009004}
9005
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009006// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
9007// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9008// R (A) --> R(A)
9009// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9010// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9011// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9012QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9013 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9014 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9015 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9016 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9017 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9018 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9019 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009020 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009021 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9022 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9023 Ret =
9024 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9025 return Ret;
9026}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009027
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009028// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9029// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9030class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9031{
9032 Sema& S;
9033 Expr* SourceExpr;
9034 const QualType& TargetType;
9035 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9036
9037 bool Complain;
9038 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9039 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009040
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009041 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9042 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009043
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009044 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9045 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9046 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009047 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009048
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009049public:
9050 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
9051 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
9052 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9053 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9054 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9055 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9056 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
9057 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9058 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
9059 {
9060 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
9061
9062 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9063 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9064 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009065 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009066 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009067
9068 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9069 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9070 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
9071 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
9072 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9073 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
9074
9075 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9076 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9077 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9078 return;
9079 }
9080 }
9081
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009082 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
9083 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009084 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009085 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009086 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009087
9088 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9089 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009090
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009091 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9092 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9093 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9094 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9095 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9096 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9097 else
9098 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9099 }
9100 }
9101 }
9102
9103private:
9104 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9105 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9106 }
9107
9108 // [ToType] [Return]
9109
9110 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9111 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9112 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9113 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9114 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9115 }
9116
9117 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9118 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9119 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9120 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9121 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9122 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9123 // static when converting to member pointer.
9124 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9125 return false;
9126 }
9127 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9128 return false;
9129
9130 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9131 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9132 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9133 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9134 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9135 // overloaded functions considered.
9136 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009137 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009138 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9139 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9140 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9141 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009142 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009143 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9144 (void)Result;
9145 return false;
9146 }
9147
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009148 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9149 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009150 // This function template specicalization works.
9151 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009152 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9153 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9154 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009155 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9156 return true;
9157 }
9158
9159 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9160 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009161 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009162 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9163 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009164 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9165 return false;
9166 }
9167 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9168 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009169
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009170 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009171 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009172 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9173 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9174 return false;
9175
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009176 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009177 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9178 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009179 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9180 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009181 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9182 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009183 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009184 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009185 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009186 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009187
9188 return false;
9189 }
9190
9191 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9192 bool Ret = false;
9193
9194 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9195 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9196 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9197 return false;
9198
9199 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9200 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9201 I != E; ++I) {
9202 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9203 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9204
9205 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9206 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9207 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9208 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9209 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9210 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9211 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9212 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9213 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9214 Ret = true;
9215 }
9216 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9217 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9218 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9219 Ret = true;
9220 }
9221 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9222 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009223 }
9224
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009225 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009226 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9227 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9228 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9229 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9230 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9231
9232 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9233 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9234 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9235 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009236
9237 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9238 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9239 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009240
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009241 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009242 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
9243 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
9244 S.PDiag(),
9245 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9246 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
9247 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
9248 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009249 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009250
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009251 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9252 // Make it the first and only element
9253 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9254 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9255 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009256 }
9257 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009258
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009259 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9260 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9261 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9262 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9263 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9264 ++I;
9265 else {
9266 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9267 Matches.set_size(N);
9268 }
9269 }
9270 }
9271
9272public:
9273 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9274 assert(Matches.empty());
9275 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9276 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9277 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009278 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009279 }
9280
9281 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9282 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9283 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9284 }
9285
9286 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9287 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9288 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9289 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9290 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9291 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9292 }
9293
9294 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9295 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9296 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9297 }
9298
9299 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9300 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9301 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9302 << OvlExpr->getName()
9303 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009304 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009305 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009306
9307 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9308
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009309 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9310
9311 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9312 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9313 return Matches[0].second;
9314 }
9315
9316 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9317 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9318 return &Matches[0].first;
9319 }
9320};
9321
9322/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9323/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9324/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9325/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9326///
9327/// @code
9328/// int f(double);
9329/// int f(int);
9330///
9331/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9332/// @endcode
9333///
9334/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9335/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9336/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9337FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009338Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9339 QualType TargetType,
9340 bool Complain,
9341 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9342 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009343 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009344
9345 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9346 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009347 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9348 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009349 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009350 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9351 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9352 else
9353 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9354 }
9355 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9356 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9357 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9358 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9359 assert(Fn);
9360 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00009361 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009362 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009363 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009364
9365 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9366 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009367 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009368}
9369
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009370/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009371/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9372///
9373/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9374/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009375/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009376/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009377FunctionDecl *
9378Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9379 bool Complain,
9380 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009381 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9382 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9383 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009384 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9385 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9386 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009387
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009388 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009389 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009390 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009391
9392 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009393 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009394
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009395 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9396 // whose type matches exactly.
9397 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009398 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9399 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009400 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9401 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009402 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9403 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9404 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009405 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009406 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9407 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009408
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009409 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9410 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9411 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9412 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9413 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9414 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009415 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00009416 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009417 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9418 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009419 Specialization, Info,
9420 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009421 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9422 (void)Result;
9423 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009424 }
9425
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009426 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9427
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009428 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009429 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009430 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009431 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9432 << ovl->getName();
9433 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009434 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009435 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009436 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009437
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009438 Matched = Specialization;
9439 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009440 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009441
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009442 return Matched;
9443}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009444
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009445
9446
9447
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009448// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9449// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9450//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009451// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009452//
9453// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9454// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9455// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9456bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9457 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9458 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009459 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009460 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009461 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009462
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009463 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009464
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009465 DeclAccessPair found;
9466 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9467 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9468 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009469 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009470 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9471 return true;
9472 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009473
9474 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9475 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9476 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9477 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9478 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9479 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9480 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009481 if (!complain) return false;
9482
9483 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9484 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9485 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9486
9487 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9488 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9489 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9490 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9491 // the static candidates were rejected.
9492 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9493 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009494 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009495
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009496 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009497 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009498 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009499
9500 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009501 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009502 SingleFunctionExpression =
9503 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009504 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9505 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9506 return true;
9507 }
9508 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009509 }
9510
9511 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9512 if (complain) {
9513 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9514 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9515 << DestTypeForComplaining
9516 << OpRangeForComplaining
9517 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009518 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9519
9520 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9521 return true;
9522 }
9523
9524 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009525 }
9526
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009527 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9528 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009529}
9530
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009531/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9532static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009533 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009534 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009535 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009536 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009537 bool PartialOverloading,
9538 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009539 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009540 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9541 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9542
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009543 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009544 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9545 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9546 return;
9547 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009548 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9549 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009550 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009551 }
9552
9553 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9554 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009555 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009556 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009557 return;
9558 }
9559
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009560 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009561}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009562
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009563/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9564/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009565void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009566 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009567 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9568 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009569
9570#ifndef NDEBUG
9571 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9572 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009573 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009574 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9575 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9576 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9577 //
9578 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9579 //
9580 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009581 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009582 //
9583 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9584 // template
9585 //
9586 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009587
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009588 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9589 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9590 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9591 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9592 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9593 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9594 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009595 }
9596 }
9597#endif
9598
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009599 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9600 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009601 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009602 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9603 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9604 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9605 }
9606
9607 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9608 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009609 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
9610 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
9611 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009612
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009613 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00009614 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00009615 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009616 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009617 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009618}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009619
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009620/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
9621/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
9622/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
9623/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
9624///
9625/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9626static bool
9627DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
9628 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
9629 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009630 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009631 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
9632 return false;
9633
9634 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +00009635 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
9636 continue;
9637
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009638 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
9639
9640 if (!R.empty()) {
9641 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9642
9643 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
9644 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
9645 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
9646 R.clear();
9647 return false;
9648 }
9649
9650 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
9651 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
9652 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009653 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009654 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009655
9656 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009657 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009658 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
9659 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009660 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009661 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009662 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009663
9664 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
9665 // declaring the function there instead.
9666 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
9667 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +00009668 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009669 AssociatedNamespaces,
9670 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009671 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Nick Lewyckyd05df512012-11-13 00:08:34 +00009672 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
9673 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
9674 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
9675 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +00009676 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
9677 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
9678 continue;
9679
9680 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a reserved
9681 // name, like __gnu_cxx.
9682 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
9683 if (NS &&
9684 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
9685 continue;
9686
9687 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009688 }
9689
9690 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9691 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009692 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009693 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9694 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9695 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009696 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009697 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9698 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00009699 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009700 } else {
9701 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
9702 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
9703 // a localized representation of a list of items.
9704 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
9705 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
9706 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
9707 }
9708
9709 // Try to recover by calling this function.
9710 return true;
9711 }
9712
9713 R.clear();
9714 }
9715
9716 return false;
9717}
9718
9719/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
9720/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
9721/// was defined.
9722///
9723/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
9724static bool
9725DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9726 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009727 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009728 DeclarationName OpName =
9729 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
9730 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
9731 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009732 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009733}
9734
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009735namespace {
9736// Callback to limit the allowed keywords and to only accept typo corrections
9737// that are keywords or whose decls refer to functions (or template functions)
9738// that accept the given number of arguments.
9739class RecoveryCallCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9740 public:
9741 RecoveryCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, unsigned NumArgs, bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs)
9742 : NumArgs(NumArgs), HasExplicitTemplateArgs(HasExplicitTemplateArgs) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009743 WantTypeSpecifiers = SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009744 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9745 }
9746
9747 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9748 if (!candidate.getCorrectionDecl())
9749 return candidate.isKeyword();
9750
9751 for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator DI = candidate.begin(),
9752 DIEnd = candidate.end(); DI != DIEnd; ++DI) {
9753 FunctionDecl *FD = 0;
9754 NamedDecl *ND = (*DI)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9755 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND))
9756 FD = FTD->getTemplatedDecl();
9757 if (!HasExplicitTemplateArgs && !FD) {
9758 if (!(FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND)) && isa<ValueDecl>(ND)) {
9759 // If the Decl is neither a function nor a template function,
9760 // determine if it is a pointer or reference to a function. If so,
9761 // check against the number of arguments expected for the pointee.
9762 QualType ValType = cast<ValueDecl>(ND)->getType();
9763 if (ValType->isAnyPointerType() || ValType->isReferenceType())
9764 ValType = ValType->getPointeeType();
9765 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = ValType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9766 if (FPT->getNumArgs() == NumArgs)
9767 return true;
9768 }
9769 }
9770 if (FD && FD->getNumParams() >= NumArgs &&
9771 FD->getMinRequiredArguments() <= NumArgs)
9772 return true;
9773 }
9774 return false;
9775 }
9776
9777 private:
9778 unsigned NumArgs;
9779 bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs;
9780};
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009781
9782// Callback that effectively disabled typo correction
9783class NoTypoCorrectionCCC : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
9784 public:
9785 NoTypoCorrectionCCC() {
9786 WantTypeSpecifiers = false;
9787 WantExpressionKeywords = false;
9788 WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
9789 WantRemainingKeywords = false;
9790 }
9791
9792 virtual bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) {
9793 return false;
9794 }
9795};
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009796
9797class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
9798 Sema &SemaRef;
9799public:
9800 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
9801 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
9802 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
9803 }
9804
9805 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
9806 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
9807 }
9808};
9809
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +00009810}
9811
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009812/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
9813///
9814/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009815static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00009816BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009817 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9818 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009819 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009820 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009821 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +00009822 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
9823 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
9824 //
9825 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
9826 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
9827 //
9828 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
9829 return ExprError();
9830 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009831
9832 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009833 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009834 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009835
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009836 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009837 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009838 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9839 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9840 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9841 }
9842
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009843 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
9844 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009845 RecoveryCallCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(), ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009846 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
9847 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
9848 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
9849 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009850 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009851 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009852 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009853 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009854 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009855 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009856
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009857 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
9858
9859 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
9860 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009861 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009862 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009863 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
9864 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009865 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +00009866 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +00009867 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009868 else
9869 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
9870
9871 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009872 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009873
9874 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009875 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009876 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009877 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009878 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
9879 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009880}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00009881
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009882/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
9883/// the given function.
9884/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
9885bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9886 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9887 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9888 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9889 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9890 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009891#ifndef NDEBUG
9892 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9893 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
9894 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
9895
9896 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
9897 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
9898 FunctionDecl *F;
9899 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
9900 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
9901 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00009902 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009903
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009904 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009905 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00009906 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009907#endif
9908
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009909 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009910 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts)) {
9911 *Result = ExprError();
9912 return true;
9913 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00009914
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009915 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
9916 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009917 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009918 *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009919
9920 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009921 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
9922 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009923 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009924 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
9925 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009926 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009927 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009928 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +00009929 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +00009930 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
9931 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
9932 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
9933 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009934 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009935 *Result = Owned(CE);
9936 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +00009937 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009938 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +00009939 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00009940
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009941 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009942 return false;
9943}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +00009944
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009945/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
9946/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
9947/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
9948static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
9949 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
9950 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9951 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9952 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
9953 Expr *ExecConfig,
9954 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
9955 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
9956 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
9957 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
9958 if (CandidateSet->empty())
9959 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
9960 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9961 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
9962 AllowTypoCorrection);
9963
9964 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009965 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009966 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009967 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +00009968 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
9969 return ExprError();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009970 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
9971 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
9972 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009973 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009974
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009975 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9976 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
9977 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009978 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009979 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *>(Args, NumArgs),
9980 RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +00009981 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
9982 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009983 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
9984 return Recovery;
9985
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009986 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009987 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009988 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009989 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
9990 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009991 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00009992 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009993
9994 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009995 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009996 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +00009997 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates,
9998 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00009999 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010000
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010001 case OR_Deleted: {
10002 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10003 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10004 << ULE->getName()
10005 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10006 << Fn->getSourceRange();
10007 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates,
10008 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +000010009
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010010 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10011 // the call in the AST.
10012 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10013 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
10014 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
10015 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
10016 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010017 }
10018
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010019 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010020 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010021}
10022
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010023/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10024/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10025/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10026/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10027/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10028/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10029ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10030 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10031 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10032 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
10033 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10034 Expr *ExecConfig,
10035 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10036 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
10037 ExprResult result;
10038
10039 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, NumArgs, LParenLoc,
10040 &CandidateSet, &result))
10041 return result;
10042
10043 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10044 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10045 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10046
10047 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
10048 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10049 &Best, OverloadResult,
10050 AllowTypoCorrection);
10051}
10052
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010053static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010054 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10055 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10056}
10057
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010058/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10059/// operator.
10060///
10061/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10062///
10063/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10064/// operator.
10065///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010066/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010067/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10068/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10069/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10070/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10071/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10072///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010073/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010074ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010075Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10076 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010077 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010078 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010079
10080 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10081 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10082 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010083 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10084 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010085
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010086 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10087 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010088
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010089 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10090 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010091
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010092 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10093 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10094 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010095 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010096 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010097 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10098 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010099 NumArgs = 2;
10100 }
10101
10102 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010103 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010104 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010105 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010106 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010107 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010108 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010109
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010110 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010111 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010112 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010113 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010114 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10115 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010116 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010117 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010118 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010119 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010120 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010121 }
10122
10123 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010124 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010125
10126 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010127 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
10128 false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010129
10130 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10131 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
10132
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010133 // Add candidates from ADL.
10134 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010135 OpLoc, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010136 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10137 CandidateSet);
10138
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010139 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010140 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010141
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010142 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10143
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010144 // Perform overload resolution.
10145 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010146 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010147 case OR_Success: {
10148 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10149 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010150
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010151 if (FnDecl) {
10152 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10153 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010154
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010155 // Convert the arguments.
10156 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010157 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010158
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010159 ExprResult InputRes =
10160 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10161 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10162 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010163 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010164 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010165 } else {
10166 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010167 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010168 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010169 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010170 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010171 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010172 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010173 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010174 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010175 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010176 }
10177
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010178 // Determine the result type.
10179 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10180 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10181 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010182
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010183 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010184 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010185 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010186 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10187 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010188
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010189 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010190 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010191 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010192 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010193 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010194
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010195 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010196 FnDecl))
10197 return ExprError();
10198
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010199 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010200 } else {
10201 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10202 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10203 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010204 ExprResult InputRes =
10205 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10206 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10207 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10208 return ExprError();
10209 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010210 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010211 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010212 }
10213
10214 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010215 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10216 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10217 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010218 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc,
10219 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs)))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010220 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10221 return ExprError();
10222
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010223 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10224 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10225 break;
10226
10227 case OR_Ambiguous:
10228 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10229 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10230 << Input->getType()
10231 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010232 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
10233 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010234 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10235 return ExprError();
10236
10237 case OR_Deleted:
10238 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10239 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10240 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10241 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10242 << Input->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010243 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10244 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010245 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010246 return ExprError();
10247 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010248
10249 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10250 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10251 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010252 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010253}
10254
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010255/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10256/// operator.
10257///
10258/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10259///
10260/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10261/// operator.
10262///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010263/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010264/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10265/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10266/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10267/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10268/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10269///
10270/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10271/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010272ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010273Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010274 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010275 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010276 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010277 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010278 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010279
10280 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10281 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10282 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10283
10284 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10285 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010286 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010287 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010288 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010289 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010290 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010291 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010292 Context.DependentTy,
10293 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010294 OpLoc,
10295 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010296
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010297 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10298 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010299 VK_LValue,
10300 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010301 Context.DependentTy,
10302 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010303 OpLoc,
10304 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010305 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010306
10307 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010308 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010309 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10310 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010311 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010312 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10313 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10314 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010315 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010316 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10317 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10318 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010319 }
10320
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010321 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10322 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10323 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010324
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010325 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10326 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10327 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010328 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10329 return ExprError();
10330
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010331 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10332 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10333 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10334 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10335 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10336 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010337 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010338 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010339
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010340 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10341 // create a built-in binary operator.
10342 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10343 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10344
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010345 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010346 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010347
10348 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010349 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010350
10351 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10352 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10353
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010354 // Add candidates from ADL.
10355 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010356 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010357 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10358 CandidateSet);
10359
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010360 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +000010361 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010362
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010363 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10364
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010365 // Perform overload resolution.
10366 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010367 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010368 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010369 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10370 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10371
10372 if (FnDecl) {
10373 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10374 // operator.
10375
10376 // Convert the arguments.
10377 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010378 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010379 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010380
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010381 ExprResult Arg1 =
10382 PerformCopyInitialization(
10383 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10384 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10385 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010386 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010387 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010388
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010389 ExprResult Arg0 =
10390 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10391 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10392 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010393 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010394 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010395 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010396 } else {
10397 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010398 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10399 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10400 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10401 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010402 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010403 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010404
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010405 ExprResult Arg1 =
10406 PerformCopyInitialization(
10407 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10408 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10409 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010410 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10411 return ExprError();
10412 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10413 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010414 }
10415
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010416 // Determine the result type.
10417 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10418 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10419 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010420
10421 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010422 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010423 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010424 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010425 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10426 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010427
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010428 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010429 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010430 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10431 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010432
10433 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010434 FnDecl))
10435 return ExprError();
10436
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010437 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10438 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10439 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10440 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10441 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10442 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10443
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010444 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010445 } else {
10446 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10447 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10448 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010449 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10450 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10451 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10452 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010453 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010454 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010455
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010456 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10457 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10458 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10459 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10460 return ExprError();
10461 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010462 break;
10463 }
10464 }
10465
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010466 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10467 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10468 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10469 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10470 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010471 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010472 break;
10473
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010474 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10475 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10476 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010477 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010478 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010479 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010480 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10481 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010482 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010483 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010484 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10485 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10486 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010487 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010488 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10489 return ExprError();
10490
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010491 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10492 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10493 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010494 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010495 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010496 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10497 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010498 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010499 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010500 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010501 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010502
10503 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010504 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010505 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010506 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010507 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010508 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010509 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010510 return ExprError();
10511
10512 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010513 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10514 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10515 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010516 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10517 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010518
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010519 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10520 // explain why it's deleted.
10521 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10522 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010523 } else {
10524 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10525 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10526 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10527 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10528 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10529 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010530 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010531 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010532 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010533 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010534
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010535 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010536 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010537}
10538
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010539ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010540Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10541 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010542 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10543 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010544 DeclarationName OpName =
10545 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10546
10547 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10548 // expression.
10549 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10550
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010551 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010552 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10553 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10554 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010555 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010556 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010557 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010558 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10559 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10560 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010561 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010562
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010563 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010564 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010565 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010566 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010567 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010568 }
10569
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010570 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10571 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10572 return ExprError();
10573 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10574 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010575
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010576 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010577 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010578
10579 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10580
10581 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
10582 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10583
10584 // Add builtin operator candidates.
10585 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
10586
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010587 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10588
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010589 // Perform overload resolution.
10590 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010591 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010592 case OR_Success: {
10593 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10594 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10595
10596 if (FnDecl) {
10597 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10598 // operator.
10599
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010600 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010601
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010602 // Convert the arguments.
10603 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010604 ExprResult Arg0 =
10605 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10606 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10607 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010608 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010609 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010610
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010611 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010612 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010613 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010614 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010615 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010616 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010617 Owned(Args[1]));
10618 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10619 return ExprError();
10620
10621 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10622
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010623 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010624 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10625 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10626 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010627
10628 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010629 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10630 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010631 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010632 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010633 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010634 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10635 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010636 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10637 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010638
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010639 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10640 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010641 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010642 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10643 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010644
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010645 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010646 FnDecl))
10647 return ExprError();
10648
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010649 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010650 } else {
10651 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10652 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10653 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010654 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10655 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10656 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10657 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010658 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010659 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10660
10661 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10662 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10663 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10664 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10665 return ExprError();
10666 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010667
10668 break;
10669 }
10670 }
10671
10672 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010673 if (CandidateSet.empty())
10674 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
10675 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
10676 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10677 else
10678 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
10679 << Args[0]->getType()
10680 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010681 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010682 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000010683 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010684 }
10685
10686 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010687 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010688 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010689 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
10690 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010691 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010692 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010693 return ExprError();
10694
10695 case OR_Deleted:
10696 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10697 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010698 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010699 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010700 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010701 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010702 return ExprError();
10703 }
10704
10705 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010706 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010707}
10708
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010709/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
10710/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
10711/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
10712/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
10713/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010714/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
10715/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010716ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010717Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
10718 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000010719 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010720 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
10721 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10722
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010723 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
10724 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010725 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010726
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010727 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
10728 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10729 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
10730 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
10731
10732 QualType fnType =
10733 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10734
10735 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10736 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
10737 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
10738
10739 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
10740 // member function we're calling.
10741 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
10742
10743 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
10744 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
10745 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
10746 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
10747
10748 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
10749 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
10750 difference.removeAddressSpace();
10751 if (difference) {
10752 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
10753 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
10754 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
10755 << qualsString
10756 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
10757 }
10758
10759 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010760 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10761 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010762 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
10763
10764 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000010765 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000010766 call, 0))
10767 return ExprError();
10768
10769 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
10770 return ExprError();
10771
10772 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
10773 }
10774
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010775 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10776 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10777 return ExprError();
10778
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010779 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010780 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000010781 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010782 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010783 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
10784 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010785 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010786 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010787 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010788 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010789 } else {
10790 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000010791 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010792
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010793 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010794 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
10795 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
10796 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010797
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010798 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010799 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010800
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010801 // FIXME: avoid copy.
10802 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10803 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10804 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10805 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10806 }
10807
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010808 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
10809 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10810
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000010811 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
10812 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
10813 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
10814 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
10815
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010816
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010817 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010818 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010819 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
10820 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000010821 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010822 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
10823 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010824 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000010825 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010826
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010827 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010828 ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010829 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000010830 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010831 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010832 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010833 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010834 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010835 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
10836 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010837 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000010838 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000010839 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010840
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010841 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
10842
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010843 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10844
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010845 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010846 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000010847 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010848 case OR_Success:
10849 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010850 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010851 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010852 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
10853 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010854 break;
10855
10856 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010857 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010858 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010859 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010860 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10861 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010862 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010863 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010864
10865 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010866 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000010867 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010868 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10869 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010870 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010871 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010872
10873 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010874 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010875 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010876 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000010877 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000010878 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010879 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
10880 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010881 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010882 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010883 }
10884
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010885 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010886
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010887 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
10888 // non-member call based on that function.
10889 if (Method->isStatic()) {
10890 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
10891 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
10892 }
10893
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000010894 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010895 }
10896
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010897 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
10898 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
10899 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10900
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010901 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010902 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010903 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE,
10904 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010905 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010906
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000010907 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010908 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010909 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010910 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010911
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010912 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000010913 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
10914 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010915 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10916 ExprResult ObjectArg =
10917 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
10918 FoundDecl, Method);
10919 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
10920 return ExprError();
10921 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
10922 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010923
10924 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010925 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
10926 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010927 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010928 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010929 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010930
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000010931 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
10932
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000010933 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000010934 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000010935
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010936 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
10937 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
10938 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
10939 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
10940
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010941 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010942 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
10943 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
10944 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
10945 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
10946
10947 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000010948 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000010949 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010950 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000010951}
10952
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010953/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
10954/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
10955/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
10956/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010957ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010958Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000010959 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010960 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010961 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010962 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
10963 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010964 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010965
10966 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10967 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
10968 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010969
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010970 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
10971 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010972
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010973 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
10974 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000010975 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000010976 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
10977 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
10978 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
10979 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010980 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000010981 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010982
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010983 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000010984 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010985 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010986
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000010987 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
10988 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
10989 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10990
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000010991 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010992 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010993 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +000010994 Object.get()->Classify(Context),
10995 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000010996 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000010997 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010998
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000010999 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011000 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11001 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011002 //
11003 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11004 //
11005 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11006 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000011007 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11008 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11009 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11010 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011011 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11012 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11013 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
11014 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11015 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011016 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11017 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000011018 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011019 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11020 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011021 NamedDecl *D = *I;
11022 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11023 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11024 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011025
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011026 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11027 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011028 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011029 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000011030
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011031 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011032 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11033 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11034 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11035 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11036 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11037 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011038
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011039 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11040 {
11041 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011042 Object.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
11043 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011044 }
11045 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011046 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011047
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011048 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11049
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011050 // Perform overload resolution.
11051 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011052 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011053 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011054 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011055 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11056 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011057 break;
11058
11059 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011060 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011061 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011062 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11063 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011064 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011065 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011066 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011067 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011068 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11069 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011070 break;
11071
11072 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011073 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011074 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011075 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011076 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
11077 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011078 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011079
11080 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011081 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011082 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11083 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011084 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011085 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011086 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011087 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
11088 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs));
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011089 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011090 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011091
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011092 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011093 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011094
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011095 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11096
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011097 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11098 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11099 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011100 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011101 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11102 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11103
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011104 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011105 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11106 return ExprError();
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011107
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011108 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11109 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11110 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011111
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011112 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011113 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011114 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11115 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011116 if (Call.isInvalid())
11117 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011118 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11119 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11120 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11121 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011122
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011123 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +000011124 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011125 }
11126
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011127 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011128
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011129 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11130 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11131 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11132 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011133
11134 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011135 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011136 return ExprError();
11137
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011138 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11139 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011140
11141 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
11142 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
11143
11144 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
11145 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
11146 // list).
11147 Expr **MethodArgs;
11148 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
11149 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11150 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
11151 } else {
11152 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
11153 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011154 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011155 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
11156 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011157
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011158 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11159 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11160 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011161 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011162 HadMultipleCandidates,
11163 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11164 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011165 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11166 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011167
11168 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11169 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011170 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11171 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11172 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11173
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011174 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011175 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011176 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs, NumArgs+1),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011177 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011178 delete [] MethodArgs;
11179
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011180 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011181 Method))
11182 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011183
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011184 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11185 // slots in the call for them.
11186 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011187 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011188 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
11189 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
11190
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011191 bool IsError = false;
11192
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011193 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011194 ExprResult ObjRes =
11195 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11196 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11197 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11198 IsError = true;
11199 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011200 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011201 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011202
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011203 // Check the argument types.
11204 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011205 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011206 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011207 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011208
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011209 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011210
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011211 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011212 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011213 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011214 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011215 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011216
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011217 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11218 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011219 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011220 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011221 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11222 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11223 IsError = true;
11224 break;
11225 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011226
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011227 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011228 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011229
11230 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11231 }
11232
11233 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11234 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11235 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Aaron Ballman4914c282012-07-20 20:40:35 +000011236 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i < NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011237 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11238 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11239 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011240 }
11241 }
11242
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011243 if (IsError) return true;
11244
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011245 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
11246
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011247 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011248 return true;
11249
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011250 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011251}
11252
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011253/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011254/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011255/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011256ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011257Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011258 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11259 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011260
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011261 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11262 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011263
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011264 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11265
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011266 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11267 //
11268 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11269 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11270 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11271 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011272 DeclarationName OpName =
11273 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011274 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011275 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011276
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011277 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011278 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011279 return ExprError();
11280
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011281 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11282 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11283 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011284
11285 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011286 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011287 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +000011288 ArrayRef<Expr *>(), CandidateSet,
11289 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011290 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011291
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011292 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11293
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011294 // Perform overload resolution.
11295 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011296 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011297 case OR_Success:
11298 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11299 break;
11300
11301 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11302 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11303 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011304 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011305 else
11306 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011307 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011308 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011309 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011310
11311 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011312 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11313 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011314 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011315 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011316
11317 case OR_Deleted:
11318 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11319 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011320 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011321 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011322 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011323 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011324 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011325 }
11326
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011327 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11328
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011329 // Convert the object parameter.
11330 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011331 ExprResult BaseResult =
11332 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11333 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11334 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011335 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011336 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011337
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011338 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011339 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011340 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011341 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11342 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011343
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011344 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11345 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11346 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011347 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011348 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011349 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011350
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011351 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011352 Method))
11353 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011354
11355 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011356}
11357
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011358/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11359/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11360ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11361 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11362 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11363 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11364 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11365 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011366
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011367 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11368 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11369 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011370
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011371 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11372
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011373 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11374 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11375 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11376 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11377 case OR_Success:
11378 case OR_Deleted:
11379 break;
11380
11381 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11382 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11383 << R.getLookupName();
11384 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11385 return ExprError();
11386
11387 case OR_Ambiguous:
11388 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11389 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11390 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011391 }
11392
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011393 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011394 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11395 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011396 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11397 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11398 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11399 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011400
11401 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11402 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011403 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
11404 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
11405 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11406 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11407 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11408 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11409 return true;
11410 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11411 }
11412
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011413 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11414 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11415 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11416
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011417 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011418 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11419 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011420 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11421
11422 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11423 return ExprError();
11424
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011425 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011426 return ExprError();
11427
11428 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11429}
11430
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011431/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11432/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11433/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11434/// dependent lookup.
11435/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11436/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11437/// is returned.
11438Sema::ForRangeStatus
11439Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11440 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11441 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11442 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11443 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11444 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11445 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11446 CandidateSet->clear();
11447 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11448 ExprResult MemberRef =
11449 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11450 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11451 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11452 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11453 MemberLookup,
11454 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11455 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11456 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11457 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11458 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11459 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11460 }
11461 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, MultiExprArg(), Loc, 0);
11462 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11463 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11464 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11465 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11466 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11467 }
11468 } else {
11469 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011470 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11471 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11472 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11473 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011474 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011475
11476 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, &Range, 1, Loc,
11477 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11478 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11479 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11480 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11481 }
11482 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11483 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11484 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11485
11486 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11487 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11488 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11489 }
11490 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, &Range, 1,
11491 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11492 OverloadResult,
11493 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11494 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11495 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11496 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11497 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11498 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11499 }
11500 }
11501 return FRS_Success;
11502}
11503
11504
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011505/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11506/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11507/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11508/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011509/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011510Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011511 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011512 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011513 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11514 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011515 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011516 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011517
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011518 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011519 }
11520
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011521 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011522 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11523 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011524 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011525 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011526 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011527 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011528 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011529 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011530
11531 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011532 ICE->getCastKind(),
11533 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011534 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011535 }
11536
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011537 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011538 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011539 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011540 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11541 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11542 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11543 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011544 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011545 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11546 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11547 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011548 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11549 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011550 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011551 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011552
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011553 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11554 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11555 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11556 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11557
11558 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11559 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11560 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11561 QualType ClassType
11562 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11563 QualType MemPtrType
11564 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11565
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011566 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11567 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11568 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011569 }
11570 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011571 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11572 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011573 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011574 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011575
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011576 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011577 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011578 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011579 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011580 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011581
11582 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011583 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11584 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011585 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011586 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11587 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011588 }
11589
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011590 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11591 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011592 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011593 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011594 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011595 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11596 Fn->getType(),
11597 VK_LValue,
11598 Found.getDecl(),
11599 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011600 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011601 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11602 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011603 }
11604
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011605 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011606 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011607 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11608 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11609 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11610 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11611 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011612
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011613 Expr *Base;
11614
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011615 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11616 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011617 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11618 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011619 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11620 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011621 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011622 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011623 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011624 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11625 Fn->getType(),
11626 VK_LValue,
11627 Found.getDecl(),
11628 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011629 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011630 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11631 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011632 } else {
11633 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11634 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011635 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011636 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011637 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11638 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11639 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11640 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011641 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011642 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011643
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011644 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11645 QualType type;
11646 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11647 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11648 type = Fn->getType();
11649 } else {
11650 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11651 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11652 }
11653
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011654 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11655 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11656 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011657 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011658 Fn,
11659 Found,
11660 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
11661 TemplateArgs,
11662 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
11663 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000011664 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011665 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011666 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011667
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011668 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011669}
11670
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011671ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011672 DeclAccessPair Found,
11673 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011674 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000011675}
11676
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000011677} // end namespace clang